blob: 9aaf22d3aa815b6574124a874bbf871f88fe2057 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau69eda352012-12-24 16:48:14 +01007 2012/12/24
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100482 - tune.zlib.memlevel
483 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485 * Debugging
486 - debug
487 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488
489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004903.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491------------------------------------
492
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493ca-base <dir>
494 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200495 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
496 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498chroot <jail dir>
499 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
500 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
501 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
502 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
503 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
504 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100505
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100506cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
507 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
508 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
509 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
510 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
511 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
512 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
513 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
514 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
515 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
516 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
517 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
518 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
519 they overlap.
520
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521crt-base <dir>
522 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
523 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
524 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526daemon
527 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
528 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
529 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
530
531gid <number>
532 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
533 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
534 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
535 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537group <group name>
538 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
539 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200541log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
543 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100544 configured with "log global".
545
546 <address> can be one of:
547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100548 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100549 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
550 port).
551
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100552 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
553 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
554 port).
555
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100556 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
557 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
558 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
559 writeable).
560
561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562
563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
566
567 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200568 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
569 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
570 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
571 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
572 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
573 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200575 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100577log-send-hostname [<string>]
578 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
579 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
580 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
581 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
582 the logs.
583
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000584log-tag <string>
585 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
586 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
587 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
588 running on the same host.
589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590nbproc <number>
591 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
592 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
593 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
594 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
595 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
596
597pidfile <pidfile>
598 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
599 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
600 starting the process. See also "daemon".
601
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100602stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200603 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
604 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
605 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
606 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
607 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
608 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
609 the number of processes used.
610
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200611stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
612 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
613 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
614 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
615 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200616
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200617 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
618 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
619 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620
621stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
622 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
623 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100624 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625
626stats maxconn <connections>
627 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
628 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630uid <number>
631 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
632 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
633 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
634 one. See also "gid" and "user".
635
636ulimit-n <number>
637 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
638 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
639 option.
640
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100641unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
642 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
643
644 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
645 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
646 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
647 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
648 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
649 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
650 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
651 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
652 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
653 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655user <user name>
656 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
657 See also "uid" and "group".
658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200659node <name>
660 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
661
662 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
663 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
664 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
665 traffic.
666
667description <text>
668 Add a text that describes the instance.
669
670 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
671 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
672 "<" and ">" characters.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006753.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676-----------------------
677
678maxconn <number>
679 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
680 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
681 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
682 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
683
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200684maxconnrate <number>
685 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
686 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
687 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
688 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
689 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
690 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
691 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
692 fairness.
693
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100694maxcomprate <number>
695 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
696 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
697 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
698 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
699 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
700 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
701 default value.
702
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100703maxcompcpuusage <number>
704 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
705 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
706 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
707 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
708 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
709 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
710 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
711 process down and from introducing high latencies.
712
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100713maxpipes <number>
714 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
715 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
716 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
717 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
718 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
719 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
720
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200721maxsslconn <number>
722 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
723 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
724 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
725 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
726 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
727 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
728 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
729
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100730maxzlibmem <number>
731 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
732 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
733 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100734 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
735 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
736 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738noepoll
739 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
740 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100741 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
743nokqueue
744 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
745 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
746 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
747
748nopoll
749 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
750 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100751 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100752 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100754nosplice
755 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
756 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
757 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100758 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100759 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
760 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
761 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
762 "option splice-response".
763
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200764spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
765 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
766 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
767 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
768 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
769 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
770
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200771tune.bufsize <number>
772 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
773 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
774 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
775 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
776 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
777 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
778 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
779 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400780 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
781 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
782 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200783
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200784tune.chksize <number>
785 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
786 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
787 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
788 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
789 checks whenever possible.
790
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100791tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
792 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
793 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
794 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
795 this value. The default value is 1.
796
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100797tune.http.cookielen <number>
798 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
799 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
800 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
801 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
802 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
803 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
804 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
805 to change this value.
806
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200807tune.http.maxhdr <number>
808 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
809 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
810 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
811 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
812 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
813 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
814 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
815 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
816 limit too high.
817
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100818tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100819 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
820 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
821 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
822 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
823 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
824 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
825 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
826 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
827 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
828 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100829
830tune.maxpollevents <number>
831 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
832 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
833 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
834 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
835 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200837tune.maxrewrite <number>
838 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
839 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
840 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
841 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
842 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
843 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
844 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
845 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
846 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
847 bufsize.
848
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200849tune.pipesize <number>
850 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
851 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
852 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
853 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
854 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
855 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
856
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100857tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
858tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
859 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
860 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
861 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
862 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
863 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
864 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
865 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
866
867tune.sndbuf.client <number>
868tune.sndbuf.server <number>
869 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
870 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
871 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
872 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
873 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
874 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
875 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
876 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
877 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
878 notifying haproxy again.
879
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100880tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100881 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
882 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
883 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
884 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
885 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
886 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
887 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
888 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
889 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
890 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100891
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100892tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
893 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
894 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
895 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
896 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
897 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
898 being used for too long.
899
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100900tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
901 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
902 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
903 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
904 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
905 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
906
907tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
908 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
909 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
910 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
911 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009133.3. Debugging
914--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915
916debug
917 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
918 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
919 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
920 system startup.
921
922quiet
923 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
924 line argument "-q".
925
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009273.4. Userlists
928--------------
929It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
930http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
931it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
932
933userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100934 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100935 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
936
937group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100938 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100939 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
940 proceeded by "users" keyword.
941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100942user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
943 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100944 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
945 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100946 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
947 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100948 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
949 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
950
951
952 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100953 userlist L1
954 group G1 users tiger,scott
955 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100956
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100957 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
958 user scott insecure-password elgato
959 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100960
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100961 userlist L2
962 group G1
963 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100965 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
966 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
967 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968
969 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200971
9723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200973----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200974It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
975haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
976pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
977identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
978or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
979Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
980known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
981the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
982process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
983during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
984tables.
985
986peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400987 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200988 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
989
990peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
991 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
992 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
993 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
994 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
995 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
996 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
997
998 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
999 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1000
1001 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1002 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1003 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1004 across all peers.
1005
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001006 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001011
1012 backend mybackend
1013 mode tcp
1014 balance roundrobin
1015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1016 stick on src
1017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001020
1021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010224. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001024
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1026 - defaults <name>
1027 - frontend <name>
1028 - backend <name>
1029 - listen <name>
1030
1031A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1032its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1033section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001034section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1037connections.
1038
1039A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1040to forward incoming connections.
1041
1042A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1043parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001045All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1046'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1047case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1048
1049Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1050logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1051proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1052However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1053name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1054
1055Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1056and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001057bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1059modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1060arbitrary criteria.
1061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1064--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001066The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1067limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1068they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1069limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001070marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001071option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001072and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1073with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1074specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001075
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001077 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1078------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1079acl - X X X
1080appsession - - X X
1081backlog X X X -
1082balance X - X X
1083bind - X X -
1084bind-process X X X X
1085block - X X X
1086capture cookie - X X -
1087capture request header - X X -
1088capture response header - X X -
1089clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001090compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1092cookie X - X X
1093default-server X - X X
1094default_backend X X X -
1095description - X X X
1096disabled X X X X
1097dispatch - - X X
1098enabled X X X X
1099errorfile X X X X
1100errorloc X X X X
1101errorloc302 X X X X
1102-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1103errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001104force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001105fullconn X - X X
1106grace X X X X
1107hash-type X - X X
1108http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001109http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001110http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111http-request - X X X
1112id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001113ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001114log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001115maxconn X X X -
1116mode X X X X
1117monitor fail - X X -
1118monitor-net X X X -
1119monitor-uri X X X -
1120option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1121option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1122option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1123option allbackups (*) X - X X
1124option checkcache (*) X - X X
1125option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1126option contstats (*) X X X -
1127option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1128option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1129option forceclose (*) X X X X
1130-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1131option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001132option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001133option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1135option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1136option httpchk X - X X
1137option httpclose (*) X X X X
1138option httplog X X X X
1139option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001141option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001142option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1143option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1144option logasap (*) X X X -
1145option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001146option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147option nolinger (*) X X X X
1148option originalto X X X X
1149option persist (*) X - X X
1150option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001151option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001152option smtpchk X - X X
1153option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1154option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1155option splice-request (*) X X X X
1156option splice-response (*) X X X X
1157option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1158option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1159-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1160option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1161option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1162option tcpka X X X X
1163option tcplog X X X X
1164option transparent (*) X - X X
1165persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1166rate-limit sessions X X X -
1167redirect - X X X
1168redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1169redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1170reqadd - X X X
1171reqallow - X X X
1172reqdel - X X X
1173reqdeny - X X X
1174reqiallow - X X X
1175reqidel - X X X
1176reqideny - X X X
1177reqipass - X X X
1178reqirep - X X X
1179reqisetbe - X X X
1180reqitarpit - X X X
1181reqpass - X X X
1182reqrep - X X X
1183-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1184reqsetbe - X X X
1185reqtarpit - X X X
1186retries X - X X
1187rspadd - X X X
1188rspdel - X X X
1189rspdeny - X X X
1190rspidel - X X X
1191rspideny - X X X
1192rspirep - X X X
1193rsprep - X X X
1194server - - X X
1195source X - X X
1196srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001197stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001198stats auth X - X X
1199stats enable X - X X
1200stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001201stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001202stats realm X - X X
1203stats refresh X - X X
1204stats scope X - X X
1205stats show-desc X - X X
1206stats show-legends X - X X
1207stats show-node X - X X
1208stats uri X - X X
1209-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1210stick match - - X X
1211stick on - - X X
1212stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001213stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001214stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001215tcp-request connection - X X -
1216tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001217tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001218tcp-response content - - X X
1219tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001220timeout check X - X X
1221timeout client X X X -
1222timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1223timeout connect X - X X
1224timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1225timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1226timeout http-request X X X X
1227timeout queue X - X X
1228timeout server X - X X
1229timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1230timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001231timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001232transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001233unique-id-format X X X -
1234unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001235use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001236use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1238 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1242---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
1244This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1245
1246
1247acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1248 Declare or complete an access list.
1249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1250 no | yes | yes | yes
1251 Example:
1252 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1253 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1254 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001256 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001257
1258
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001259appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1260 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1263 no | no | yes | yes
1264 Arguments :
1265 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1266 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1267
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001268 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269 checked in each cookie value.
1270
1271 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1272 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1273 milliseconds.
1274
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001275 request-learn
1276 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1277 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1278 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1279 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1280 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1281 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1282
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001283 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1284 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1285 data following this prefix.
1286
1287 Example :
1288 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1289
1290 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1291 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1292
1293 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1294 2 modes are currently supported :
1295 - path-parameters :
1296 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1297 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1298 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1299 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1300 - query-string :
1301 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1302 query string.
1303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1305 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1306 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1307 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001308 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1309 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1310 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1312 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1313
1314 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1315
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001316 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1317 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1318 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001320 Example :
1321 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001323 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1324 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001325
1326
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001327backlog <conns>
1328 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1330 yes | yes | yes | no
1331 Arguments :
1332 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1333 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001334 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001335
1336 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1337 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1338 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1339 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1340 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1341 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1342 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1343 backlog parameter.
1344
1345 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1346 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1347 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1348
1349 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1350
1351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001353balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1356 yes | no | yes | yes
1357 Arguments :
1358 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1359 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1360 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1361 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1362
1363 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1364 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1365 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1366 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001367 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1368 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1369 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1370 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1371 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1372 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1373 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1374 it, so that you don't worry.
1375
1376 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1377 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1378 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1379 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1380 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1381 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1382 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1383 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001384
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001385 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1386 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1387 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1388 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1389 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1390 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1391 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1392 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1393
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001394 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1395 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1396 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1397 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001398 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001399 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1400 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1401 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1402 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1403 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001404 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1405 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1406 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1407 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1408 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1409 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001411 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1412 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1413 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1414 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1415 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1416 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1417 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1418 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001419 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001421 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1422 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1423 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001425 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1426 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1427 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1428 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1429 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1430 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1431 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1432 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1433 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1434 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1435 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1436 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001438 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001439 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1440 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1441 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1442 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1443 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1444 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1445 URIs start with a leading "/".
1446
1447 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1448 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1449 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1450 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001453 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1454
1455 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001456 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1457 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1458 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1459 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1460 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1461 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1462 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1463 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1464 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1465 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1466 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1467 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1468 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1469 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1470 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1471 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1472 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1473 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1474 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001475
1476 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1477 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1478 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1479 server will receive the request.
1480
1481 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1482 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1483 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1484 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1485 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001486 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1487 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1488 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001490 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1491 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1492 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1493 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1494 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001496 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001497 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1498 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1499 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1500
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001501 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1502 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1503 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1504
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001505 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001506 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001507 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1508 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1509 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1510 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1511 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1512 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001513 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001514 used instead.
1515
1516 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1517 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1518 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1519 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1520
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001521 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1522 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1523 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1524
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001528 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1529 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001530
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001531 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001532 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001534 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1535 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1536 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001537
1538 Examples :
1539 balance roundrobin
1540 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001541 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001542 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1543 balance hdr(host)
1544 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001545
1546 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1547 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001550 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1551 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1552 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1553 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1554
1555 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1556 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1557 defaults to 16 kB.
1558
1559 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1560 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1561
1562 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1563 Round Robin.
1564
1565 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1566 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1567 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1568 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1569
1570 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1571
1572 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001573 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001574 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1575 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1576 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001578 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1579 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
1581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001582bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1583bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1586 no | yes | yes | no
1587 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001588 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1589 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1590 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1591 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001592 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001593
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001594 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1595 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001596 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1597 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1598 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001599 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1600 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1601 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1602 the range.
1603
1604 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1605 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1606 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1607 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1608 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1609 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1610 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001611 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001612 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001614 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1615 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1616 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1617 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1618 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1619 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1620 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1621 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001623 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1624 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1625 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1626 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1629 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1630 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1631 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1632 in a frontend.
1633
1634 Example :
1635 listen http_proxy
1636 bind :80,:443
1637 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001638 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001640 listen http_https_proxy
1641 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001642 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001643
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001644 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001645 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
1647
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001648bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001649 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1651 yes | yes | yes | yes
1652 Arguments :
1653 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1654 may be used to override a default value.
1655
1656 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1657 option may be combined with other numbers.
1658
1659 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1660 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1661 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1662 missing from all processes.
1663
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001664 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1665 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1666 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1667 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1668 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001669
1670 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1671 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1672 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1673 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1674 and 'even' instances.
1675
1676 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1677 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1678 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1679 32.
1680
1681 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1682 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen app_ip1
1686 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001687 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001688
1689 listen app_ip2
1690 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001691 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001692
1693 listen management
1694 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001695 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001696
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001697 listen management
1698 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1699 bind-process 1-4
1700
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001701 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1702
1703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704block { if | unless } <condition>
1705 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1707 no | yes | yes | yes
1708
1709 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1710 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001711 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001712 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1714 "block" statements per instance.
1715
1716 Example:
1717 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1718 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1719 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1720 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001722 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723
1724
1725capture cookie <name> len <length>
1726 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1728 no | yes | yes | no
1729 Arguments :
1730 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1731 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1732 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1733 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1734 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1735
1736 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1737 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1738 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1739 right if it exceeds <length>.
1740
1741 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1742 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1743 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1744 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1745
1746 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1747 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1748 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1749
1750 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1751 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1752 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001753 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1754 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1755 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756
1757 Example:
1758 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1759
1760 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001761 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
1763
1764capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001765 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 no | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001770 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1772 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1773 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1774
1775 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1776 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1777 it exceeds <length>.
1778
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001779 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1781 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001782 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1783 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1784 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1785 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001786 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001787 environments to find where the request came from.
1788
1789 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1790 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1791 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1792 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001794 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1795 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1796 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1797 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1798 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799
1800 Example:
1801 capture request header Host len 15
1802 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1803 capture request header Referrer len 15
1804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001805 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 about logging.
1807
1808
1809capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001810 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1812 no | yes | yes | no
1813 Arguments :
1814 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001815 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1817 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1818 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1819
1820 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1821 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1822 it exceeds <length>.
1823
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001824 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1826 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1827 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001828 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1829 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1830 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1831 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001833 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1834 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1835 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1836 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1837 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838
1839 Example:
1840 capture response header Content-length len 9
1841 capture response header Location len 15
1842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001843 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 about logging.
1845
1846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001847clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1850 yes | yes | yes | no
1851 Arguments :
1852 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1854 as explained at the top of this document.
1855
1856 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1857 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1858 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1859 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1860 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1861 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1862 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1863 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001864 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1866 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1867
1868 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1870 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1871 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1872 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1873 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1874
1875 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1876 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1877
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001878 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1879 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001881compression algo <algorithm> ...
1882compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001883compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001884 Enable HTTP compression.
1885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1886 yes | yes | yes | yes
1887 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001888 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1889 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1890 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1891
1892 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001893 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001894 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1895 data.
1896
1897 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1898 support for zlib was built in.
1899
1900 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1901 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1902 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1903 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1904 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1905 in.
1906
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001907 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001908 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001909 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1910 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1911 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1912 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1913 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001914
1915 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1916 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1917 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1918 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1919 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001920 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1921 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1922 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1923 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1924 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1925 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001926
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001927 Compression is disabled when:
1928 * the server is not HTTP/1.1.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001929 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001930 * requests does not contain Transfer-Encoding: chunked or Content-Length.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001931 * Content-Type is multipart
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001932 * the request contains "Cache-control: no-transform".
1933 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" except MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7 and later.
1934 * The response is already compressed (see compression offload).
1935
1936 The compression does not rewrite Etag headers
1937
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001938 Examples :
1939 compression algo gzip
1940 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001942contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1945 yes | no | yes | yes
1946 Arguments :
1947 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1949 as explained at the top of this document.
1950
1951 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001952 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001953 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1955 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1956 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1957 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1958
1959 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1960 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1961 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1962 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1963 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1964 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1965
1966 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1967 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1968 instead.
1969
1970 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1971 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1972
1973
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001974cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001975 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1976 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1979 yes | no | yes | yes
1980 Arguments :
1981 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1982 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1983 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1984 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1985 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1986 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1987 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1988 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1989 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1990
1991 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1992 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1993 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1994 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1995 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1996 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1997 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1998 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1999 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2000 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2001 "insert" and "prefix".
2002
2003 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002004 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002005
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002006 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002007 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2008 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2009 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2010 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2011 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2012 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2013 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2014 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2015 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2016 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2019 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2020 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2021 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2022 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2023 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2024 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2025 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2026 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2027 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002028 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2029 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2030 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002032 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2033 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2034 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002035 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2036 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2037 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2038 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002039 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2040 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2041 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
2043 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2044 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2045 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2046 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2047 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2048 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2049 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2050 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2051 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2052
2053 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2054 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2055 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2056 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2057 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2058 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2059 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2060 persistence cookie in the cache.
2061 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2062
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002063 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2064 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2065 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2066 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2067 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2068 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2069 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2070 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2071 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2072 they logout.
2073
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002074 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2075 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2076 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2077 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2078
2079 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2080 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2081 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2082 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2083 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2084 this attribute.
2085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002086 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002087 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002088 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2089 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2090 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2091 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2092 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2093 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002094
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002095 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2096 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2097 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2098 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2099 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2100 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2101 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2102 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2103 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2104 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2105 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2106 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2107 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2108 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2109 the site.
2110
2111 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2112 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2113 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2114 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2115 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2116 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2117 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2118 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2119 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2120 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2121 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2122 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2123 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2124 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2125 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2126 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2129 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2130 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2131 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002133 Examples :
2134 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2135 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2136 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002137 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002139 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002140 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002143default-server [param*]
2144 Change default options for a server in a backend
2145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2146 yes | no | yes | yes
2147 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002148 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2149 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2150 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2151 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002152
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002153 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002154 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2155
2156 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159default_backend <backend>
2160 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2162 yes | yes | yes | no
2163 Arguments :
2164 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2165
2166 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2167 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2168 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2169 will catch all undetermined requests.
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 Example :
2172
2173 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2174 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2175 default_backend dynamic
2176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002177 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179
2180disabled
2181 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | yes | yes | yes
2184 Arguments : none
2185
2186 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2187 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2188 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2189 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2190 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2191 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2192 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2193
2194 See also : "enabled"
2195
2196
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002197dispatch <address>:<port>
2198 Set a default server address
2199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2200 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002201 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002202
2203 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2204 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2205 during start-up.
2206
2207 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2208 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2209 possible with normal servers.
2210
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002211 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002212 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2213 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2214 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2215 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2216
2217 See also : "server"
2218
2219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002220enabled
2221 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 yes | yes | yes | yes
2224 Arguments : none
2225
2226 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2227 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2228
2229 See also : "disabled"
2230
2231
2232errorfile <code> <file>
2233 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | yes
2236 Arguments :
2237 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002238 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002239
2240 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002241 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002243 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2244 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2247 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2248 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2249
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002250 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2253 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2254 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2255 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2256
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002257 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2258 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2259 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2260 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2261 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2262 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2265 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2266 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002267 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2269
2270 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2271
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002272 Example :
2273 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2274 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2275 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2276
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002277
2278errorloc <code> <url>
2279errorloc302 <code> <url>
2280 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2282 yes | yes | yes | yes
2283 Arguments :
2284 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002285 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002286
2287 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2288 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2289 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2290 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2291 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2292
2293 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2294 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2295 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2296
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002297 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002299 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2300 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2301 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2302 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2303 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2304 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2305 request.
2306
2307 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2308
2309
2310errorloc303 <code> <url>
2311 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2316 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2317
2318 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2319 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2320 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2321 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2322 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002330 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2331 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2332 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2333 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002334 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002335
2336 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2337
2338
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002339force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2340 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2342 no | yes | yes | yes
2343
2344 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2345 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2346 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2347 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2348 marked down for maintenance operations.
2349
2350 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2351 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2352 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2353 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2354 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2355 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2356 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2357 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2358 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2359
2360 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2361 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2362 is used.
2363
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002364 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002365 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002366
2367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002368fullconn <conns>
2369 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2371 yes | no | yes | yes
2372 Arguments :
2373 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2374 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2375
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002376 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002378 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002379 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2380 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2381 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2382 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2383 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002384 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002385
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002386 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2387 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2388 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2389
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002390 Example :
2391 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2392 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2393 # connections.
2394 backend dynamic
2395 fullconn 10000
2396 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2397 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2398
2399 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2400
2401
2402grace <time>
2403 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002406 Arguments :
2407 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2408 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2409 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2410
2411 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2412 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002413 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002414 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2415
2416 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2417 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2418 simplify it.
2419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002421hash-type <method>
2422 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2424 yes | no | yes | yes
2425 Arguments :
2426 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2427 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2428 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2429 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2430 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2431 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2432 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2433 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2434 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2435
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002436 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2437 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2438 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2439 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2440 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2441 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2442 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2443 this value.
2444
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002445 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2446 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2447 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2448 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2449 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2450 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2451 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2452 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2453 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2454 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2455 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2456 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2457 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2458
2459 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2460
2461 See also : "balance", "server"
2462
2463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464http-check disable-on-404
2465 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002467 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 Arguments : none
2469
2470 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2471 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2472 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2473 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2474 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2475 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2476 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2477 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002478 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2479 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2480 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2481
2482 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2483
2484
2485http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002486 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002489 Arguments :
2490 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2491 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002492 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002493 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2494 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2495 details on the supported keywords.
2496
2497 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2498 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2499 with the usual backslash ('\').
2500
2501 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2502 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2503 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2504 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2505 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2506
2507 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002508 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002509 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2510 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2511 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2512
2513 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002514 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002515 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2516 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2517 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2518 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2519
2520 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002521 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002522 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2523 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2524 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2525 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2526 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2527 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2528 trace).
2529
2530 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002531 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002532 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2533 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2534 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2535 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2536 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2537 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2538
2539 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2540 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2541 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2542 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2543 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2544 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2545 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2546 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2547
2548 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2549 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2550
2551 Examples :
2552 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002553 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002554
2555 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002556 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002557
2558 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002559 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002560
2561 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002562 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002563
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002564 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565
2566
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002567http-check send-state
2568 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 yes | no | yes | yes
2571 Arguments : none
2572
2573 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2574 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2575 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2576 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2577 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2578
2579 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2580 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2581 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2582 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2583 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2584 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2585 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2586 checked in multiple backends.
2587
2588 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2589 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2590
2591 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2592 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2593 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2594 one fails.
2595
2596 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2597 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2598 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2599
2600 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2601 server's queue.
2602
2603 Example of a header received by the application server :
2604 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2605 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2606
2607 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2608
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002609http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] |
2610 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002611 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002612 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2613
2614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 no | yes | yes | yes
2616
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002617 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2618 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2619 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2620 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2621 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002623 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2624 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2625 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2626
2627 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2628 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2629 are evaluated.
2630
2631 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2632 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2633 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2634 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2635 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2636
2637 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2638 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2639 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2640 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2641 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2642 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2643 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2644 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2645
2646 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2647 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2648 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2649 external users.
2650
2651 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2652
2653 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2654 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2655 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2656 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002657
2658 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002659 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2660 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2661 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002662
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002663 http-request allow if nagios
2664 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2665 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2666 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002667
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002668 Example:
2669 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002670 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002671
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002672 Example:
2673 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2674 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2675 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2676 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2677 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2682
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002683 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2684 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002685
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002686http-send-name-header [<header>]
2687 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2688
2689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2690 yes | no | yes | yes
2691
2692 Arguments :
2693
2694 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2695
2696 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2697 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2698 is added with the header string proved.
2699
2700 See also : "server"
2701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002702id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002703 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 no | yes | yes | yes
2706 Arguments : none
2707
2708 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2709 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2710 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002711
2712
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002713ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2714 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2716 no | yes | yes | yes
2717
2718 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2719 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2720 and running).
2721
2722 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2723 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2724 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2725 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2726 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2727
2728 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2729 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2730
2731 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2732 "unless" condition is met.
2733
2734 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2735
2736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002737log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002738log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002739no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002740 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2742 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002743
2744 Prefix :
2745 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2746 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2747 prefix does not allow arguments.
2748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749 Arguments :
2750 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2751 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2752 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2753 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2754 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2755 parameter.
2756
2757 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2758 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2759
2760 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2761 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2762 standard syslog port).
2763
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002764 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2765 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2766 standard syslog port).
2767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002768 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2769 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2770 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2771 appropriately writeable).
2772
2773 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2774
2775 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2776 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2777 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2778
2779 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2780 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2781 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002782 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2783 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2784 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2785 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2786 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787
2788 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2789
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002790 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2791 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2792 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002793
2794 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2795 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2796 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2797 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2798
2799 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2800 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002801
2802 Example :
2803 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002804 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2805 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002806
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002807log-format <string>
2808 Allows you to custom a log line.
2809
2810 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002812
2813maxconn <conns>
2814 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 yes | yes | yes | no
2817 Arguments :
2818 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2819 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2820 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2821 closes.
2822
2823 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2824 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2825 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2826 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2827 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2828 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2829 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2830 properly tuned.
2831
2832 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2833 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2834 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2835
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002836 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002838 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2839
2840
2841mode { tcp|http|health }
2842 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | yes | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
2846 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2847 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2848 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2849 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2850
2851 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2852 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2853 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2854 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2855 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2856
2857 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002858 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2859 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2860 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2861 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2862 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2863 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2864 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002866 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2867 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2868 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002870 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002871 defaults http_instances
2872 mode http
2873
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002874 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002877monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002878 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 Arguments :
2882 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2883 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002884 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2886 backend and its backup.
2887
2888 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2889 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2890 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2891 servers in a list of backends.
2892
2893 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2894 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2895 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2896 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2897 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2898 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2899 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002900 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2901 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902
2903 Example:
2904 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002905 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2907 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2908 monitor-uri /site_alive
2909 monitor fail if site_dead
2910
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002911 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002912
2913
2914monitor-net <source>
2915 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | no
2918 Arguments :
2919 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2920 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2921 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2922 followed by a mask.
2923
2924 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2925 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002926 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002927 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2928
2929 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2930 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2931 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2932 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002933 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2934 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2935 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002936
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002937 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2938 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2939 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2940 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2941 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2942 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002943
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002944 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2945 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002947 Example :
2948 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2949 frontend www
2950 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2951
2952 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2953
2954
2955monitor-uri <uri>
2956 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2958 yes | yes | yes | no
2959 Arguments :
2960 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2961 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2962
2963 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2964 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2965 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2966 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2967 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2968 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2969 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2970 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2971
2972 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2973 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2974 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2975 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2976 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2977 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2978
2979 Example :
2980 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2981 frontend www
2982 mode http
2983 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2984
2985 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002987
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002988option abortonclose
2989no option abortonclose
2990 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2992 yes | no | yes | yes
2993 Arguments : none
2994
2995 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2996 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2997 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2998 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002999 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3001 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3002 encountered while delivering the response.
3003
3004 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3005 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3006 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3007 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3008 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3009 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003010 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003011 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003012 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003013 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3014 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3015 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3016
3017 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3018 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3019 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3020 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3021 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3022 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3023 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3024 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003025 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003026
3027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3029
3030 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3031
3032
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003033option accept-invalid-http-request
3034no option accept-invalid-http-request
3035 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3037 yes | yes | yes | no
3038 Arguments : none
3039
3040 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3041 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3042 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3043 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3044 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3045 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3046 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3047 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003048 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3049 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3050 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3051 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3052 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3053 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003054
3055 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3056 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3057 been confirmed.
3058
3059 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3060 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003061 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3062 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003063 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3064
3065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3067
3068 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3069 stats socket.
3070
3071
3072option accept-invalid-http-response
3073no option accept-invalid-http-response
3074 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | no | yes | yes
3077 Arguments : none
3078
3079 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3080 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3081 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3082 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3083 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3084 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3085 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3086 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3087 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3088
3089 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3090 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3091 been confirmed.
3092
3093 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3094 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3095 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3096 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3097
3098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3100
3101 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3102 stats socket.
3103
3104
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003105option allbackups
3106no option allbackups
3107 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3109 yes | no | yes | yes
3110 Arguments : none
3111
3112 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3113 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3114 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3115 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3116 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3117 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3118 order between the backup servers anymore.
3119
3120 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3121 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3122
3123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3125
3126
3127option checkcache
3128no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003129 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 yes | no | yes | yes
3132 Arguments : none
3133
3134 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3135 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003136 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003137 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3138 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003139 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003140
3141 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003142 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003143 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003144 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3145 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003146 to the client are :
3147 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003148 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003149 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003150 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3151 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3152 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3153 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3154 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3155 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3156 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3157 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3158 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3159 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3160 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3161
3162 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003163 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003164 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003165 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003166 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3167
3168 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3169 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003170 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003171 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3172
3173 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3174 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3175
3176
3177option clitcpka
3178no option clitcpka
3179 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3181 yes | yes | yes | no
3182 Arguments : none
3183
3184 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3185 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3186 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3187 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3188
3189 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3190 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3191 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3192 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3193
3194 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3195 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3196 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3197 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3198 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3199
3200 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3201
3202 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3203 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3204 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3205
3206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3208
3209 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3210
3211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212option contstats
3213 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3215 yes | yes | yes | no
3216 Arguments : none
3217
3218 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3219 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3220 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3221 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3222 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3223 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3224 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3225
3226
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003227option dontlog-normal
3228no option dontlog-normal
3229 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3231 yes | yes | yes | no
3232 Arguments : none
3233
3234 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3235 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3236 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3237 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3238 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3239 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3240 logged.
3241
3242 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3243 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3244 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003246 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003247 logging.
3248
3249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003250option dontlognull
3251no option dontlognull
3252 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 yes | yes | yes | no
3255 Arguments : none
3256
3257 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3258 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3259 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3260 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3261 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3262 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3263 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3264
3265 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3266 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3267 would not be logged.
3268
3269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003272 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003273
3274
3275option forceclose
3276no option forceclose
3277 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003280 Arguments : none
3281
3282 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3283 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3284 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3285 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3286 global session times in the logs.
3287
3288 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003289 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003290 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3291 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3292 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3293 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003294
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003295 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3296 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3297 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3298
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3301
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003302 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003303
3304
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003305option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003306 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3308 yes | yes | yes | yes
3309 Arguments :
3310 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3311 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003312 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003313 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003314
3315 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3316 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3317 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3318 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3319 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3320 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3321 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003322 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3323 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3324 possible that the client has already brought one.
3325
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003326 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003327 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003328 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3329 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003330 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3331 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003332
3333 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3334 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3335 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3336 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3337 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3338 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3339 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3340
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003341 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3342 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3343 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3344 are under the control of the end-user.
3345
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003346 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003347 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3348 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003349 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3350 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3351 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003352
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003353 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3354 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3355 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3356 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3357 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003358
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003359 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003360 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3361 frontend www
3362 mode http
3363 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3364
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003365 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3366 backend www
3367 mode http
3368 option forwardfor header X-Client
3369
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003370 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3371 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003372
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003373
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003374option http-no-delay
3375no option http-no-delay
3376 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
3379 Arguments : none
3380
3381 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3382 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3383 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3384 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3385 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3386 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3387 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3388 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3389 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3390 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3391 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3392 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3393 affected.
3394
3395 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3396 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3397 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3398 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3399 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3400 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3401 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3402 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3403 latency environments.
3404
3405
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003406option http-pretend-keepalive
3407no option http-pretend-keepalive
3408 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 yes | yes | yes | yes
3411 Arguments : none
3412
3413 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3414 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3415 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3416 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3417 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3418 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3419 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3420 consider the response complete.
3421
3422 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3423 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3424 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3425 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3426 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3427 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3428
3429 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3430 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3431 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3432 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3433 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3434 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3435 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3436
3437 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3438 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003439 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003440 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3441 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003442
3443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3445
3446 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3447
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003448
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003449option http-server-close
3450no option http-server-close
3451 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3453 yes | yes | yes | yes
3454 Arguments : none
3455
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003456 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3457 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3458 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3459 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3460 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3461 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3462 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3463 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3464 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3465 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3466 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3467 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003468
3469 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3470 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3471 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3472 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003473 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3474 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003475
3476 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3477 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003478 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3479 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3480 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003481
3482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3484
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003485 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3486 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003487
3488
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003489option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003490no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003491 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | yes | yes | no
3494 Arguments : none
3495
3496 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3497 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3498 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3499 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3500 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3501 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3502 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3503
3504 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3505 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3506 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3507 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3508 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3509 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3510 request along its whole life.
3511
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003512 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3513 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3514 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3515 front of an existing proxy.
3516
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003517 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3518
3519 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3520 http-server-close".
3521
3522
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003523option httpchk
3524option httpchk <uri>
3525option httpchk <method> <uri>
3526option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3527 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3529 yes | no | yes | yes
3530 Arguments :
3531 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3532 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3533 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3534 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3535 ones.
3536
3537 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3538 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3539 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3540
3541 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3542 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3543 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3544 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3545 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3546
3547 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3548 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3549 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3550 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3551 the lack of any response.
3552
3553 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3554
3555 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3556 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3557 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3558
3559 Examples :
3560 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3561 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3562 backend https_relay
3563 mode tcp
3564 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3565 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3566
3567 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003568 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3569 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003570
3571
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003572option httpclose
3573no option httpclose
3574 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | yes | yes | yes
3577 Arguments : none
3578
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003579 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3580 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3581 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3582 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3583 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3584 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3585 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003586
3587 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003588 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003589 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3590 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3591 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3592 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3593 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003594
3595 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3596 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3597 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003598 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3599 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003600
3601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3603
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003604 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3605 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003606
3607
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003608option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003609 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3611 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003612 Arguments :
3613 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3614 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3615 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3616 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3617 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003618
3619 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3620 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3621 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3622 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3623 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3624 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3625 ports.
3626
3627 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3628
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3631 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3632 by default.
3633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003634 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003635
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003636
3637option http_proxy
3638no option http_proxy
3639 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | yes | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : none
3643
3644 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3645 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3646 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3647 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3648 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3649
3650 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3651 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3652 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3653 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003654 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003655 be analyzed.
3656
3657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3659
3660 Example :
3661 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3662 backend direct_forward
3663 option httpclose
3664 option http_proxy
3665
3666 See also : "option httpclose"
3667
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003668
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003669option independent-streams
3670no option independent-streams
3671 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | yes
3674 Arguments : none
3675
3676 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3677 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3678 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3679 receive data or not.
3680
3681 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3682 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3683 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3684 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3685 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3686 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3687 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3688 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3689 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3690 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3691 socket buffers.
3692
3693 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3694 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3695 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3696 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3697 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3698
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003699 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3700 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3701 deprecated.
3702
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003703 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003704
3705
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003706option ldap-check
3707 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 yes | no | yes | yes
3710 Arguments : none
3711
3712 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3713 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3714 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3715 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3716
3717 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3718 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3719
3720 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3721 configure it.
3722
3723 Example :
3724 option ldap-check
3725
3726 See also : "option httpchk"
3727
3728
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003729option log-health-checks
3730no option log-health-checks
3731 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | no | yes | yes
3734 Arguments : none
3735
3736 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3737 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3738 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3739 of additional information is limited.
3740
3741 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3742 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3743
3744 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3745
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003746
3747option log-separate-errors
3748no option log-separate-errors
3749 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | yes | yes | no
3752 Arguments : none
3753
3754 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3755 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3756 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3757 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3758 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3759 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3760 provides very important information.
3761
3762 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3763 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3764 error logs.
3765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003766 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003767 logging.
3768
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003769
3770option logasap
3771no option logasap
3772 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | yes | yes | no
3775 Arguments : none
3776
3777 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3778 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3779 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3780 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3781 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3782 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3783 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003784 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003785 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3786 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003788 Examples :
3789 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3790 mode http
3791 option httplog
3792 option logasap
3793 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3794
3795 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3796 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3797 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3798 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003800 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003801 logging.
3802
3803
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003804option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3805 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003808 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003809 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3810 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003811
3812 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3813 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3814 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3815 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3816 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3817 in the MySQL table, like this :
3818
3819 USE mysql;
3820 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3821 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3822
3823 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3824 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3825 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3826 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3827 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3828 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3829 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3830 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3831 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3832
3833 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3834 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003835
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003836 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003837
3838 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3839 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3840 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3841 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3842 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3843 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3844
3845 See also: "option httpchk"
3846
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003847option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3848 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3850 yes | no | yes | yes
3851 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003852 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3853 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003854
3855 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3856 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3857 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3858 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3859
3860 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003861
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003862option nolinger
3863no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003864 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003867 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003868
3869 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3870 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3871 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3872 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3873 connections.
3874
3875 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3876 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3877 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3878 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3879 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3880 this too.
3881
3882 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3883 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3884 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3885
3886 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3887 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3888 for servers.
3889
3890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3892
3893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003894option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3895 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 yes | yes | yes | yes
3898 Arguments :
3899 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3900 matching <network>
3901 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3902 header name.
3903
3904 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3905 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3906 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3907 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3908 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3909 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3910 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3911 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3912 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3913 possible that the client has already brought one.
3914
3915 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3916 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3917 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3918 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3919 header and requires different one.
3920
3921 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3922 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3923 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3924 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3925 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3926 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3927 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3928
3929 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3930 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3931 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3932 both are defined.
3933
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003934 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3935 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3936 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3937 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3938 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003939
3940 Examples :
3941 # Original Destination address
3942 frontend www
3943 mode http
3944 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3945
3946 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3947 backend www
3948 mode http
3949 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3950
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003951 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3952 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003953
3954
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003955option persist
3956no option persist
3957 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003960 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003961
3962 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3963 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3964 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3965 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3966 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3967 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3968 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3969 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3970 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3971 redirected to another valid server.
3972
3973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3975
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003976 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003977
3978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003979option redispatch
3980no option redispatch
3981 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003984 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003985
3986 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3987 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3988 be able to access the service anymore.
3989
3990 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3991 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3992
3993 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3994 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3995 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003996
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003997 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3998 "redisp" keywords.
3999
4000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4002
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004003 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004004
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004005
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004006option redis-check
4007 Use redis health checks for server testing
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | no | yes | yes
4010 Arguments : none
4011
4012 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4013 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4014 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4015 find the "+PONG" response message.
4016
4017 Example :
4018 option redis-check
4019
4020 See also : "option httpchk"
4021
4022
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004023option smtpchk
4024option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4025 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004029 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4030 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4031 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4032
4033 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4034 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4035 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4036
4037 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4038 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4039 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4040 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4041 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4042 dead server.
4043
4044 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4045 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4046 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4047 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4048
4049 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4050 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4051 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4052 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4053 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4054
4055 Example :
4056 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4057
4058 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004061option socket-stats
4062no option socket-stats
4063
4064 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 yes | yes | yes | no
4067
4068 Arguments : none
4069
4070
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004071option splice-auto
4072no option splice-auto
4073 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4075 yes | yes | yes | yes
4076 Arguments : none
4077
4078 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4079 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4080 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4081 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004082 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004083 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4084 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4085 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4086 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4087
4088 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4089 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4090 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4091 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4092 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4093 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4094 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4095 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4096 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4097 keyword.
4098
4099 Example :
4100 option splice-auto
4101
4102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4104
4105 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4106 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4107
4108
4109option splice-request
4110no option splice-request
4111 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4113 yes | yes | yes | yes
4114 Arguments : none
4115
4116 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004117 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004118 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4119 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4120 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4121 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4122
4123 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4124
4125 Example :
4126 option splice-request
4127
4128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4130
4131 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4132 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4133
4134
4135option splice-response
4136no option splice-response
4137 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4139 yes | yes | yes | yes
4140 Arguments : none
4141
4142 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004143 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004144 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4145 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4146 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4147 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4148
4149 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4150
4151 Example :
4152 option splice-response
4153
4154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4156
4157 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4158 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4159
4160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004161option srvtcpka
4162no option srvtcpka
4163 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | no | yes | yes
4166 Arguments : none
4167
4168 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4169 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4170 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4171 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4172
4173 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4174 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4175 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4176 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4177
4178 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4179 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4180 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4181 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4182 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4183
4184 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4185
4186 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4187 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4188 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4189
4190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4192
4193 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4194
4195
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004196option ssl-hello-chk
4197 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4199 yes | no | yes | yes
4200 Arguments : none
4201
4202 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4203 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4204 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4205 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4206 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4207 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4208 hello message.
4209
4210 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4211 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4212 messages, which is appreciable.
4213
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004214 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4215 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4216 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004217
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004218 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4219
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004220
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004221option tcp-smart-accept
4222no option tcp-smart-accept
4223 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 yes | yes | yes | no
4226 Arguments : none
4227
4228 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4229 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4230 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4231 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4232 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4233 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4234
4235 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4236 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4237 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4238 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4239
4240 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4241 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4242 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4243 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4244
4245 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4246 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4247 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4248
4249 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4250 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4251 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4252
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004253 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4254
4255
4256option tcp-smart-connect
4257no option tcp-smart-connect
4258 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | no | yes | yes
4261 Arguments : none
4262
4263 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4264 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4265 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4266 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4267 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4268
4269 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4270 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4271 complex.
4272
4273 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4274 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4275 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4276
4277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4279
4280 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4281
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004282
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004283option tcpka
4284 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4286 yes | yes | yes | yes
4287 Arguments : none
4288
4289 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4290 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4291 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4292 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4293
4294 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4295 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4296 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4297 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4298
4299 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4300 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4301 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4302 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4303 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4304
4305 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4306
4307 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4308 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4309 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4310 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4311 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4312 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4313 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4314 backends.
4315
4316 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4317
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004318
4319option tcplog
4320 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | yes | yes | yes
4323 Arguments : none
4324
4325 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4326 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4327 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4328 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4329 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4330 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4331 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4332 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4333
4334 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004336 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004337
4338
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004339option transparent
4340no option transparent
4341 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004343 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004344 Arguments : none
4345
4346 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4347 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4348 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4349 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4350 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4351 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4352 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4353 appropriate server.
4354
4355 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4356 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4357
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004358 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004359 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004360
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004361
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004362persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004363persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004364 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 yes | no | yes | yes
4367 Arguments :
4368 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004369 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4370 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004371
4372 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4373 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4374 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4375 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4376 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4377 forwarded to this server.
4378
4379 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4380 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4381 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004382 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004383 a single "listen" section.
4384
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004385 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4386 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4387 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4388
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004389 Example :
4390 listen tse-farm
4391 bind :3389
4392 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4393 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4394 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4395 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4396 persist rdp-cookie
4397 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004398 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004399 balance rdp-cookie
4400 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4401 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4402
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004403 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4404 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004405
4406
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004407rate-limit sessions <rate>
4408 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | no
4411 Arguments :
4412 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4413 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4414
4415 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4416 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4417 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4418 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4419 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4420 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4421
4422 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4423 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4424 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4425 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4426
4427 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4428 listen smtp
4429 mode tcp
4430 bind :25
4431 rate-limit sessions 10
4432 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4433
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004434 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4435 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4436 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004437
4438 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4439
4440
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004441redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4442redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4443redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004444 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 no | yes | yes | yes
4447
4448 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004449 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004450
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004451 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004452 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4453 the HTTP "Location" header.
4454
4455 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4456 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4457 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4458 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4459 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4460 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4461
4462 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4463 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4464 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4465 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4466 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4467 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4468 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4469 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4470 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004471
4472 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4473 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4474 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4475 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4476 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4477 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4478 location with a GET method.
4479
4480 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4481 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4482
4483 - "drop-query"
4484 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4485 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4486 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4487 with a location-type redirect.
4488
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004489 - "append-slash"
4490 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4491 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4492 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4493 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4494
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004495 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4496 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4497 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4498 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4499 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4500 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4501 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4502
4503 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4504 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4505 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4506 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4507 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4508 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4509 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004510
4511 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4512 acl clear dst_port 80
4513 acl secure dst_port 8080
4514 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004515 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004516 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004517 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4518
4519 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004520 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4521 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4522 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004523 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004524
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004525 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4526 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4527 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4528
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004529 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004530 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004532 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004533
4534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004535redisp (deprecated)
4536redispatch (deprecated)
4537 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4539 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004540 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004541
4542 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4543 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4544 be able to access the service anymore.
4545
4546 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4547 redistribute them to a working server.
4548
4549 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4550 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4551 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004553 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4554 "option redispatch" instead.
4555
4556 See also : "option redispatch"
4557
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004558
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004559reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004560 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 no | yes | yes | yes
4563 Arguments :
4564 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4565 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004566 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004567
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004568 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4569 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4570
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004571 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4572 the last header of an HTTP request.
4573
4574 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4575 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4576 responses.
4577
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004578 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4579 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4580 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4581
4582 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4583 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004584
4585
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004586reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4587reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004588 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4590 no | yes | yes | yes
4591 Arguments :
4592 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4593 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4594 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4595 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4596 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4597 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4598 ignores case.
4599
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004600 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4601 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4602
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4604 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4605 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4606 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004607 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608
4609 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4610 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4611
4612 Example :
4613 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4614 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4615 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4616
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004617 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4618 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004619
4620
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004621reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4622reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004623 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 no | yes | yes | yes
4626 Arguments :
4627 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4628 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4629 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4630 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4631 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4632 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004634 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4635 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4636
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4638 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4639 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4640 next servers.
4641
4642 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4643 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4644 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4645
4646 Example :
4647 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4648 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4649 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4650
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004651 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4652 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004653
4654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004655reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4656reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004657 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4659 no | yes | yes | yes
4660 Arguments :
4661 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4662 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4663 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4664 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4665 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4666 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4667 case.
4668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004669 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4670 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4671
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004672 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4673 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4674 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4675 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004676 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004677
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004678 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004679 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004680 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004681
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4683 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4684
4685 Example :
4686 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4687 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4688 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4689
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004690 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4691 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004692
4693
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004694reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4695reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004696 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 no | yes | yes | yes
4699 Arguments :
4700 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4701 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4702 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4703 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4704 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4705 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4706 case.
4707
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004708 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4709 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4710
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004711 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4712 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4713 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4714 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4715
4716 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4717 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4718
4719 Example :
4720 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4721 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4722 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4723 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4724
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004725 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4726 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004727
4728
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004729reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4730reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004731 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 no | yes | yes | yes
4734 Arguments :
4735 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4736 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4737 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4738 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4739 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4740 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4741
4742 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4743 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4744 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4745 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004746 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004748 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4749 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4750
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004751 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4752 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4753 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4754
4755 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4756 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4757 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4758 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4759 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4760
4761 Example :
4762 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004763 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004764 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4765 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4766
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004767 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4768 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004769
4770
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004771reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4772reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004773 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 no | yes | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4778 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4779 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4780 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4781 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4782 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4783 ignores case.
4784
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004785 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4786 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4787
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004788 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4789 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004790 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4791 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4792 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004793 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4794 not set.
4795
4796 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4797 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4798 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4799 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4800 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4801
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004802 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004803 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4804 # block all others.
4805 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4806 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4807
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004808 # block bad guys
4809 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4810 reqitarpit . if badguys
4811
4812 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4813 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004814
4815
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004816retries <value>
4817 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4819 yes | no | yes | yes
4820 Arguments :
4821 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4822 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4823 default value is 3.
4824
4825 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4826 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4827 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4828
4829 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4830 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4831
4832 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4833 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4834
4835 See also : "option redispatch"
4836
4837
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004838rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004839 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 no | yes | yes | yes
4842 Arguments :
4843 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4844 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004845 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004846
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004850 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4851 the last header of an HTTP response.
4852
4853 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4854 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4855 responses.
4856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004857 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4858 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004859
4860
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004861rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4862rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004863 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 no | yes | yes | yes
4866 Arguments :
4867 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4868 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4869 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4870 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4871 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4872 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4873 ignores case.
4874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004875 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4876 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4877
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004878 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4879 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004880 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004881 client.
4882
4883 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4884 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4885 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4886
4887 Example :
4888 # remove the Server header from responses
4889 reqidel ^Server:.*
4890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004891 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4892 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004893
4894
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004895rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4896rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004897 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 no | yes | yes | yes
4900 Arguments :
4901 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4902 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4903 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4904 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4905 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4906 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4907 ignores case.
4908
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004909 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4910 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4911
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004912 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4913 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4914 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4915 case-sensitive.
4916
4917 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004918 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4919 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4920 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004921
4922 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4923 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4924
4925 Example :
4926 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4927 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4928
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004929 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4930 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004931
4932
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004933rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4934rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004935 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4937 no | yes | yes | yes
4938 Arguments :
4939 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4940 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4941 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4942 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4943 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4944 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4945 ignores case.
4946
4947 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4948 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4949 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4950 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004951 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004952
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004953 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4954 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4955
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004956 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4957 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4958 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4959
4960 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4961 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4962 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4963 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4964 are not case-sensitive.
4965
4966 Example :
4967 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4968 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4969
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004970 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4971 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004972
4973
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004974server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004975 Declare a server in a backend
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 no | no | yes | yes
4978 Arguments :
4979 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004980 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004981 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004982
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004983 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4984 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4985 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4986 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004987 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4988 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4989 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4990 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4991 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4992 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004994 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004995 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4996 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4997 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4998 adding this value to the client's port.
4999
5000 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5001 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005002 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005003
5004 Examples :
5005 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5006 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
5007
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005008 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5009 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005010
5011
5012source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005013source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005014source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005015 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | no | yes | yes
5018 Arguments :
5019 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5020 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
5021 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
5022 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
5023
5024 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5025 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005026 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5027 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5028 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005029
5030 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5031 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5032 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5033 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5034 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5035 <addr>.
5036
5037 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5038 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5039 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5040 port.
5041
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005042 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5043 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5044 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5045 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
5046 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
5047 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5048 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5049 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5050 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5051 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5052 HTTP header.
5053
5054 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5055 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005056 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005057 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5058 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5059 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5060 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5061 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5062 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5063 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5064
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005065 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5066 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5067 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5068 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5069 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5070 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5071
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005072 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5073 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5074 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5075 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5076
5077 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5078 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5079 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5080 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5081 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5082 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5083
5084 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5085 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5086 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5087 there are two methods :
5088
5089 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5090 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5091 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5092 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5093 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5094 of the client ranges may be used.
5095
5096 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5097 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5098 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5099 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5100 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5101 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5102 same session.
5103
5104 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5105 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5106 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5107 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5108 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5109 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5110
5111 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5112 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5113 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005114 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005115
5116 Examples :
5117 backend private
5118 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5119 source 192.168.1.200
5120
5121 backend transparent_ssl1
5122 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5123 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5124
5125 backend transparent_ssl2
5126 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5127 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5128 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5129
5130 backend transparent_ssl3
5131 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5132 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5133 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5134
5135 backend transparent_smtp
5136 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5137 # with Tproxy version 4.
5138 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5139
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005140 backend transparent_http
5141 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5142 # proxy.
5143 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005145 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005146 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005148
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005149srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5150 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | no | yes | yes
5153 Arguments :
5154 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5155 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5156 as explained at the top of this document.
5157
5158 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5159 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5160 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5161 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5162 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5163 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5164 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5165
5166 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5167 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5168 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5169 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5170 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005171 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005172 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005173 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005174
5175 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5176 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5177 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5178 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5179 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5180 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5181
5182 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5183 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5184
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005185 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5186 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005187
5188
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005189stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5190 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 no | no | yes | yes
5193
5194 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5195 matched.
5196
5197 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5198 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5199
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005200 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5201 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5202 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5203
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005204 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5205 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5206 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5207 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005208
5209 Example :
5210 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5211 backend stats_localhost
5212 stats enable
5213 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5214
5215 Example :
5216 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5217 backend stats_auth
5218 stats enable
5219 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5220 stats admin if TRUE
5221
5222 Example :
5223 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5224 userlist stats-auth
5225 group admin users admin
5226 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5227 group readonly users haproxy
5228 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5229
5230 backend stats_auth
5231 stats enable
5232 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5233 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5234 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5235 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5236
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005237 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5238 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5239 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005240
5241
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005242stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5243 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5245 yes | no | yes | yes
5246 Arguments :
5247 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5248
5249 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5250
5251 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5252 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5253 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5254 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5255 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5256 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5257
5258 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5259 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5260 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005261 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005262
5263 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5264 report using "stats scope".
5265
5266 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5267 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5268 unobvious parameters.
5269
5270 Example :
5271 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5272 backend public_www
5273 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5274 stats enable
5275 stats hide-version
5276 stats scope .
5277 stats uri /admin?stats
5278 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5279 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5280 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5281
5282 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5283 backend private_monitoring
5284 stats enable
5285 stats uri /admin?stats
5286 stats refresh 5s
5287
5288 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5289
5290
5291stats enable
5292 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 yes | no | yes | yes
5295 Arguments : none
5296
5297 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5298 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5299 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5300 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5301 - stats auth : no authentication
5302 - stats scope : no restriction
5303
5304 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5305 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5306 unobvious parameters.
5307
5308 Example :
5309 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5310 backend public_www
5311 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5312 stats enable
5313 stats hide-version
5314 stats scope .
5315 stats uri /admin?stats
5316 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5317 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5318 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5319
5320 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5321 backend private_monitoring
5322 stats enable
5323 stats uri /admin?stats
5324 stats refresh 5s
5325
5326 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5327
5328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005329stats hide-version
5330 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5332 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005333 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005334
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005335 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5336 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5337 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5338 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5339 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5340 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005342 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5343 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5344 unobvious parameters.
5345
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005346 Example :
5347 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5348 backend public_www
5349 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005350 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005351 stats hide-version
5352 stats scope .
5353 stats uri /admin?stats
5354 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5355 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5356 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005357
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005358 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5359 backend private_monitoring
5360 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005361 stats uri /admin?stats
5362 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005363
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005364 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005365
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005366
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005367stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5368 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369 Access control for statistics
5370
5371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 no | no | yes | yes
5373
5374 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5375 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5376 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5377 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5378 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5379 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5380
5381 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5382 instance.
5383
5384 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5385 about ACL usage.
5386
5387
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005388stats realm <realm>
5389 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392 Arguments :
5393 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5394 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5395 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5396
5397 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5398 using a backslash ('\').
5399
5400 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5401 only related to authentication.
5402
5403 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5404 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5405 unobvious parameters.
5406
5407 Example :
5408 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5409 backend public_www
5410 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5411 stats enable
5412 stats hide-version
5413 stats scope .
5414 stats uri /admin?stats
5415 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5416 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5417 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5418
5419 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5420 backend private_monitoring
5421 stats enable
5422 stats uri /admin?stats
5423 stats refresh 5s
5424
5425 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5426
5427
5428stats refresh <delay>
5429 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432 Arguments :
5433 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5434 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5435 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5436 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5437 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5438 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5439
5440 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5441 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5442 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5443 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5444
5445 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5446 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5447 unobvious parameters.
5448
5449 Example :
5450 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5451 backend public_www
5452 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5453 stats enable
5454 stats hide-version
5455 stats scope .
5456 stats uri /admin?stats
5457 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5458 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5459 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5460
5461 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5462 backend private_monitoring
5463 stats enable
5464 stats uri /admin?stats
5465 stats refresh 5s
5466
5467 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5468
5469
5470stats scope { <name> | "." }
5471 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5473 yes | no | yes | yes
5474 Arguments :
5475 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5476 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5477 section in which the statement appears.
5478
5479 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5480 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5481 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5482 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5483 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5484 exists.
5485
5486 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5487 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5488 unobvious parameters.
5489
5490 Example :
5491 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5492 backend public_www
5493 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5494 stats enable
5495 stats hide-version
5496 stats scope .
5497 stats uri /admin?stats
5498 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5499 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5500 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5501
5502 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5503 backend private_monitoring
5504 stats enable
5505 stats uri /admin?stats
5506 stats refresh 5s
5507
5508 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5509
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005510
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005511stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005512 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 yes | no | yes | yes
5515
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005516 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005517 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5518
5519 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5520 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5521
5522 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5523 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005524 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005525
5526 Example :
5527 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5528 backend private_monitoring
5529 stats enable
5530 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5531 stats uri /admin?stats
5532 stats refresh 5s
5533
5534 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5535 global section.
5536
5537
5538stats show-legends
5539 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5540 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5541 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5542 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5543 - IP (socket, server)
5544 - cookie (backend, server)
5545
5546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005548 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005549
5550 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5551
5552
5553stats show-node [ <name> ]
5554 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5556 yes | no | yes | yes
5557 Arguments:
5558 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5559 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5560
5561 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5562 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005563 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005564
5565 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5566 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5567 unobvious parameters.
5568
5569 Example:
5570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5571 backend private_monitoring
5572 stats enable
5573 stats show-node Europe-1
5574 stats uri /admin?stats
5575 stats refresh 5s
5576
5577 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5578 section.
5579
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005580
5581stats uri <prefix>
5582 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5584 yes | no | yes | yes
5585 Arguments :
5586 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5587 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5588 query string.
5589
5590 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5591 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5592 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5593 possible to reach it in the application.
5594
5595 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005596 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005597 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5598 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5599 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5600 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5601
5602 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5603 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5604 an address or a port to statistics only.
5605
5606 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5607 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5608 unobvious parameters.
5609
5610 Example :
5611 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5612 backend public_www
5613 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5614 stats enable
5615 stats hide-version
5616 stats scope .
5617 stats uri /admin?stats
5618 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5619 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5620 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5621
5622 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5623 backend private_monitoring
5624 stats enable
5625 stats uri /admin?stats
5626 stats refresh 5s
5627
5628 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5629
5630
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005631stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5632 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005634 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005635
5636 Arguments :
5637 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5638 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5639 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5640 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5641
5642 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5643 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5644 the "stick-table" statement.
5645
5646 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5647 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5648 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5649 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5650 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5651
5652 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5653 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5654 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5655 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5656 transformation rules.
5657
5658 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5659 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5660 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5661 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5662 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5663 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5664 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5665
5666 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5667 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5668 ACL based conditions.
5669
5670 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5671 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5672 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5673 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5674
5675 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5676 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5677 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5678 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005680 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5681 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5682 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5683
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005684 Example :
5685 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5686 # last 30 minutes
5687 backend pop
5688 mode tcp
5689 balance roundrobin
5690 stick store-request src
5691 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5692 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5693 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5694
5695 backend smtp
5696 mode tcp
5697 balance roundrobin
5698 stick match src table pop
5699 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5700 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5701
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005702 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5703 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005704
5705
5706stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5707 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 no | no | yes | yes
5710
5711 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5712 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5713 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5714 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5715
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005716 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5717 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5718 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5719
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005720 Examples :
5721 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005722 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005723
5724 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5725 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5726 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5727
5728
5729 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5730 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5731 backend http
5732 mode http
5733 balance roundrobin
5734 stick on src table https
5735 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5736 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5737 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5738
5739 backend https
5740 mode tcp
5741 balance roundrobin
5742 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5743 stick on src
5744 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5745 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5746
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005747 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005748
5749
5750stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5751 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5753 no | no | yes | yes
5754
5755 Arguments :
5756 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5757 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5758 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5759 server is selected.
5760
5761 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5762 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5763 the "stick-table" statement.
5764
5765 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5766 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5767 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5768 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5769 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5770 address.
5771
5772 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5773 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5774 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5775 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5776 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5777 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5778 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5779 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5780 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5781 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5782
5783 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5784 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5785 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5786 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5787 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5788 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5789 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5790
5791 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5792 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5793 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5794 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5795
5796 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5797 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5798 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5799 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5800 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5801 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5802 another protocol or access method.
5803
5804 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5805 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5806 the request.
5807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005808 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5809 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5810 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005812 Example :
5813 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5814 # last 30 minutes
5815 backend pop
5816 mode tcp
5817 balance roundrobin
5818 stick store-request src
5819 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5820 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5821 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5822
5823 backend smtp
5824 mode tcp
5825 balance roundrobin
5826 stick match src table pop
5827 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5828 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5829
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005830 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5831 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005832
5833
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005834stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005835 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5836 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005837 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005839 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005840
5841 Arguments :
5842 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5843 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5844 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5845 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5846
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005847 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5848 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5849 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5850 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5851
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005852 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5853 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5854 instance.
5855
5856 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5857 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5858 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5859 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5860 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5861 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005862 to 32 characters.
5863
5864 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5865 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5866 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5867 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5868 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5869 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005870
5871 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005872 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5873 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005874 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5875 increase.
5876
5877 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005878 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5879 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5880 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005881
5882 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5883 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5884 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5885 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5886 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5887 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5888 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5889 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5890 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5891 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5892 parameter (see below).
5893
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005894 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5895 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5896 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5897 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5898 soft restart.
5899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005900 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005902 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5903 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5904 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5905 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5906 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005907 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005908 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5909 if not expiration delay is specified.
5910
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005911 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5912 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5913 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5914 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005915 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5916 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5917 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5918 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5919 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5920 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5921 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5922 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5923 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5924 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5925 types and their arguments.
5926
5927 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5928 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5929 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5930 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5931
5932 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5933 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5934 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5935 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5936
5937 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5938 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5939 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5940 they were received.
5941
5942 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5943 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5944 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5945 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5946 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5947
5948 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5949 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5950 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5951 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5952 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5953
5954 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5955 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5956 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5957
5958 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5959 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5960 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5961 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5962 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5963
5964 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5965 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5966 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5967 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5968 the client side.
5969
5970 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5971 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5973 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5974 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5975 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5976 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5977
5978 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5979 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5980 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5981 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5982 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5983 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5984 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5985
5986 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5987 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5988 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5989 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5990 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5991 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5992
5993 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5994 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5995 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5996 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5997
5998 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5999 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6000 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6001 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6002 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6003 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6004 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6005 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6006 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6007 recommended for better fairness.
6008
6009 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6010 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6011 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6012 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6013
6014 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6015 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6016 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6017 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6018 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6019 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6020 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6021 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6022 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6023 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006024
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006025 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6026 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006027 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6028 reference it.
6029
6030 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6031 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6032 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6033 as an exclusive stickiness.
6034
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006035 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6036 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6037 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6038 something that can be ignored.
6039
6040 Example:
6041 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6042 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6043 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6044 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6045
6046 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006047 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006048
6049
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006050stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6051 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6053 no | no | yes | yes
6054
6055 Arguments :
6056 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6057 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6058 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6059 server is selected.
6060
6061 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6062 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6063 the "stick-table" statement.
6064
6065 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6066 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6067 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6068 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6069
6070 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6071 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6072 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6073 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6074 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6075 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006076 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006077 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6078 rules.
6079
6080 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6081 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6082 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6083 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6084 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6085 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6086 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6087
6088 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6089 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6090 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6091 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6092
6093 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6094 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6095 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6096 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6097 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6098 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6099 another protocol or access method.
6100
6101 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6102
6103 Example :
6104 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6105 backend https
6106 mode tcp
6107 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006108 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006109 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006110
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006111 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6112 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6113
6114 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6115 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6116 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6117
6118 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6119 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006120
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006121 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6122 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6123 # at offset 44.
6124
6125 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6126 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6127
6128 # Learn on response if server hello.
6129 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006130
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006131 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6132 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6133
6134 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6135 extraction.
6136
6137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006138tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6139 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006142 Arguments :
6143 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6144 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6145 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006147 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006148
6149 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6150 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006151 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6152 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6153 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6154 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6155 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6156 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006158 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6159 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6160 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6161 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006163 Three types of actions are supported :
6164 - accept :
6165 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6166 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6167 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006169 - reject :
6170 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6171 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6172 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6173 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6174 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6175 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6176 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6177 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6178 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6179 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6180 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6181 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006183 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6184 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6185 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6186 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6187 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6188 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6189 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6190 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6191 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006193 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006194 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6195 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6196 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6197 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6198 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6199 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006201 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6202 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6203 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6204 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006206 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6207 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6208 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6209 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6210 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006211 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6212 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6213 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6214 layer7 information is extracted.
6215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006216 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6217 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6218 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6219 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6220 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006222 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6223 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6224 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006226 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6227 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6228 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006230 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006231 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006232 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006234 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6235 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6236 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006238 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6239 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6240 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006241
6242 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006244 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006245
6246
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006247tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6248 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006250 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006251 Arguments :
6252 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6253 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6254 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006256 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006258 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6259 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6260 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6261 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6262 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006264 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6265 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6266 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6267 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6268 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6269 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6270 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6271 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6272 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006274 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6275 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6276 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6277 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006279 Three types of actions are supported :
6280 - accept :
6281 - reject :
6282 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006284 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6285 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006287 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6288 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6289 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006290 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6291 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6292 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6293 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6294 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6295 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006297 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006298 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6299 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006301 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006302 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6303 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6304 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6305 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6306 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006307
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006308 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6309 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6310 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6311 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6312
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006313 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006314 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6315 # and reject everything else.
6316 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6317 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006318 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006319 tcp-request content reject
6320
6321 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006322 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6323 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6324 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006325 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006326
6327 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6328 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6329 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006330 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006331 tcp-request content reject
6332
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006333 Example:
6334 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6335 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6336 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6337
6338 Example:
6339 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6340 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6341 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006343 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6344 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6345
6346 frontend http
6347 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6348 # protecting all our sites
6349 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6350 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6351 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6352 ...
6353 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6354
6355 backend http_dynamic
6356 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6357 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6358 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6359 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6360 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6361 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6362 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006364 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006366 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006367
6368
6369tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6370 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006372 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006373 Arguments :
6374 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6375 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6376 as explained at the top of this document.
6377
6378 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6379 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6380 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6381 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6382 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6383
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006384 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6385 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6386 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6387 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6388
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006389 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6390 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006391 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006392 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006393 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6394 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6395 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6396 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006397
6398 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6399 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6400 it pass through unaffected.
6401
6402 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6403 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6404 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006405 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006406 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6407 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006408 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6409 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6410 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006411
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006412 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006413 "timeout client".
6414
6415
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006416tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6417 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 no | no | yes | yes
6420 Arguments :
6421 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6422 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6423 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6424
6425 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6426
6427 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6428 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6429 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6430 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006431 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006432
6433 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6434
6435 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6436 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6437 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6438 inserted.
6439
6440 Two types of actions are supported :
6441 - accept :
6442 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6443 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6444 the rules evaluation.
6445
6446 - reject :
6447 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6448 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006449 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006450
6451 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6452 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6453 for changing the default action to a reject.
6454
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006455 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6456 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6457 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6458 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006459 period.
6460
6461 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6462
6463 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6464
6465
6466tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6467 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6469 no | no | yes | yes
6470 Arguments :
6471 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6472 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6473 as explained at the top of this document.
6474
6475 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6476
6477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006478timeout check <timeout>
6479 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6480 established.
6481
6482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments:
6485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6487 as explained at the top of this document.
6488
6489 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6490 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6491 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6492 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006493 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6494 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6495 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006496
6497 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6498 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6499
6500 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6501 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006502 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006503
6504 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6506 forget about it.
6507
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006508 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6509 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006510
6511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006512timeout client <timeout>
6513timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6514 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 yes | yes | yes | no
6517 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6520 as explained at the top of this document.
6521
6522 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6523 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6524 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6525 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6526 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6527 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6528 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6529 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006530 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006531 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006532 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6533 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6534 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006535
6536 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6538 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6539 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6540 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6541 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6542
6543 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6544 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6545 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6546
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006547 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006548
6549
6550timeout connect <timeout>
6551timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6552 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | no | yes | yes
6555 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006556 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006557 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6558 as explained at the top of this document.
6559
6560 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006561 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006562 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006563 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006564 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6565 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006566
6567 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6568 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6569 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6570 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6571 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6572 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6573
6574 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6575 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6576 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6577
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006578 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6579 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006580
6581
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006582timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6583 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6585 yes | yes | yes | yes
6586 Arguments :
6587 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6588 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6589 as explained at the top of this document.
6590
6591 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6592 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6593 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6594 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6595 once the request has started to present itself.
6596
6597 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6598 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6599 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6600 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6601 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6602
6603 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6604 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6605 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6606 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6607
6608 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6609 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6610 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6611 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6612 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006613 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006614
6615 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6616 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6617 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6618 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6619
6620 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6621
6622
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006623timeout http-request <timeout>
6624 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6630 as explained at the top of this document.
6631
6632 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6633 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6634 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6635 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6636 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6637 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6638 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6639 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6640
6641 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6642 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006643 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6644 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006645
6646 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6647 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6648 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6649 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6650 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6651
6652 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006653 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6654 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6655 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006656
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006657 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006658
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006659
6660timeout queue <timeout>
6661 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6663 yes | no | yes | yes
6664 Arguments :
6665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6667 as explained at the top of this document.
6668
6669 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6670 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6671 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6672 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6673 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6674
6675 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6676 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6677 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6678 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6679
6680 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6681
6682
6683timeout server <timeout>
6684timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6685 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | no | yes | yes
6688 Arguments :
6689 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6690 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6691 as explained at the top of this document.
6692
6693 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6694 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6695 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6696 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6697 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6698 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6699 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6700
6701 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6702 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6703 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6704 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6705 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006706 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006707 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006708 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6709 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6710 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6711 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006712
6713 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6715 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6716 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6717 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6718 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6719
6720 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6721 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6722 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6723
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006724 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006725
6726
6727timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006728 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6730 yes | yes | yes | yes
6731 Arguments :
6732 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6734 as explained at the top of this document.
6735
6736 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6737 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6738 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6739
6740 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6741 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6742 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6743 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006744 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006745
6746 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6747
6748
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006749timeout tunnel <timeout>
6750 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | no | yes | yes
6753 Arguments :
6754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6756 as explained at the top of this document.
6757
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006758 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006759 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6760 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6761 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6762 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6763 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6764 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6765 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6766 specified.
6767
6768 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6769 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6770 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6771 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6772 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6773
6774 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6776 forget about it.
6777
6778 Example :
6779 defaults http
6780 option http-server-close
6781 timeout connect 5s
6782 timeout client 30s
6783 timeout client 30s
6784 timeout server 30s
6785 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6786
6787 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6788
6789
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006790transparent (deprecated)
6791 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006794 Arguments : none
6795
6796 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6797 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6798 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6799 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6800 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6801 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6802 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6803 appropriate server.
6804
6805 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6806
6807 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6808 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6809
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006810 See also: "option transparent"
6811
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006812unique-id-format <string>
6813 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6815 yes | yes | yes | no
6816 Arguments :
6817 <string> is a log-format string.
6818
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006819 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6820 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6821 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6822 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006823
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006824 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6825 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6826 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6827 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6828 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6829 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6830 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6831 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006833 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6834 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006835
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006836 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006837
6838 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6839
6840 will generate:
6841
6842 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6843
6844 See also: "unique-id-header"
6845
6846unique-id-header <name>
6847 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 yes | yes | yes | no
6850 Arguments :
6851 <name> is the name of the header.
6852
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006853 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6854 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006855
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006856 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006857
6858 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6859 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6860
6861 will generate:
6862
6863 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6864
6865 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006866
6867use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6868use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006869 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6871 no | yes | yes | no
6872 Arguments :
6873 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006875 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006876
6877 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6878 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6879 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006880 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6881 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6882 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6883 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006884
6885 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6886 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6887 assign the backend.
6888
6889 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6890 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6891 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6892 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6893 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6894 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6895
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006896 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006897 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006898 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6899 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6900 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6901
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006902 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006903
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006904
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006905use-server <server> if <condition>
6906use-server <server> unless <condition>
6907 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 no | no | yes | yes
6910 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006911 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006912
6913 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6914
6915 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6916 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6917 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6918
6919 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6920 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6921 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6922 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6923 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6924 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6925 matches will assign the server.
6926
6927 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6928 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6929 with the next rules until one matches.
6930
6931 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6932 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6933 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6934 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6935
6936 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6937 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6938 stripped.
6939
6940 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6941 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6942 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6943 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6944
6945 Example :
6946 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6947 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6948 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6949 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6950 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6951 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6952 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6953 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6954 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6955
6956 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6957
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006958
69595. Bind and Server options
6960--------------------------
6961
6962The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6963depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6964settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6965written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6966described in this section.
6967
6968
69695.1. Bind options
6970-----------------
6971
6972The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6973as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6974no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6975parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6976while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6977provided immediately after the setting name.
6978
6979The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6980
6981accept-proxy
6982 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6983 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6984 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6985 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6986 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6987 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6988 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6989 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6990 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6991 usable.
6992
6993backlog <backlog>
6994 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6995 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6996
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006997ecdhe <named curve>
6998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6999 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
7000 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
7001
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007002ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7004 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7005 client's certificate.
7006
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007007ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7009 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7010 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7011 error is ignored.
7012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007013ciphers <ciphers>
7014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7015 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7016 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7017 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7018 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7019
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007020crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7022 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7023 to verify client's certificate.
7024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007025crt <cert>
7026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7027 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7028 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007029 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7030 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7031 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7032 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7033 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7034 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7035 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7036 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007037 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007038 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7039 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7040 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7041 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7042 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007043
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007044crt-ignore-err <errors>
7045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7046 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7047 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7048 error is ignored.
7049
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007050defer-accept
7051 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7052 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7053 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7054 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7055 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7056 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7057 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7058 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7059 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7060 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7061 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7062
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007063force-sslv3
7064 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7065 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7066 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7067
7068force-tlsv10
7069 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7070 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7071
7072force-tlsv11
7073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7074 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7075
7076force-tlsv12
7077 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7078 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007080gid <gid>
7081 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7082 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7083 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7084 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7085 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7086
7087group <group>
7088 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7089 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7090 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7091 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7092 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7093
7094id <id>
7095 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7096 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7097 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7098 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7099
7100interface <interface>
7101 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
7102 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
7103 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
7104 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
7105 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
7106 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
7107 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
7108 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
7109
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007110level <level>
7111 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7112 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7113 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7114 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7115 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7116 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7117 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7118 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7119 counters).
7120 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7121 all counters).
7122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007123maxconn <maxconn>
7124 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7125 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7126 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7127 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7128 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7129 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7130 eat all memory.
7131
7132mode <mode>
7133 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7134 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7135 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7136 UNIX sockets.
7137
7138mss <maxseg>
7139 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7140 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7141 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7142 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7143 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7144 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7145 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7146 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7147 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7148 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7149 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7150
7151name <name>
7152 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7153 page.
7154
7155nice <nice>
7156 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7157 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7158 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7159 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7160 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7161 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7162 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7163 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7164 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7165 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7166 one for an RDP socket.
7167
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007168no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7170 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7171 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007172 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7173 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007174
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007175no-tls-tickets
7176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7177 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7178 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7179 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7180
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007181no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007183 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7184 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7185 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7186 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007187
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007188no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007190 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7191 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7192 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7193 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007194
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007195no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007197 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7198 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7199 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7200 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007201
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007202npn <protocols>
7203 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7204 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7205 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7206 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7207 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7208
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007209ssl
7210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7211 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7212 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7213 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7214 to deciphered contents.
7215
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007216tfo
7217 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7218 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7219 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7220 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7221 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7222 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7223 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7224 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7225 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7226
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007227transparent
7228 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7229 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7230 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7231 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7232 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7233 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7234 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7235 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7236 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7237 so check for support with your vendor.
7238
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007239v4v6
7240 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7241 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7242 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7243 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7244 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7245
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007246v6only
7247 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7248 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7249 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007250 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7251 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007253uid <uid>
7254 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7255 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7256 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7257 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7258 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7259
7260user <user>
7261 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7262 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7263 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7264 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7265 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7266
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007267verify [none|optional|required]
7268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7269 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7270 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7271 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7272 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007273 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7274 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7275 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7276 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007277
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020072785.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007279------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007281The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7282which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7283arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7284settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7285after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7286Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7287address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007289 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007290 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007292The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007293
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007294addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007295 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7296 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7297 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7298 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7299 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007301 Supported in default-server: No
7302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007303backup
7304 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7305 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7306 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7307 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7308 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7309 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007311 Supported in default-server: No
7312
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007313ca-file <cafile>
7314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7315 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7316 server's certificate.
7317
7318 Supported in default-server: No
7319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007320check
7321 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007322 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7323 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7324 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7325 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7326 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7327 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7328 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7329 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7330 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7331 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007333 Supported in default-server: No
7334
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007335check-send-proxy
7336 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7337 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7338 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7339 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7340 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7341 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7342 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7343
7344 Supported in default-server: No
7345
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007346check-ssl
7347 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7348 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7349 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7350 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7351 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7352 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7353 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7354 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7355 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7356
7357 Supported in default-server: No
7358
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007359ciphers <ciphers>
7360 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7361 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7362 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7363 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7364 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7365 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7366 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7367 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7368
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007369 Supported in default-server: No
7370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007371cookie <value>
7372 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7373 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7374 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7375 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7376 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7377 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7378 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007380 Supported in default-server: No
7381
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007382crl-file <crlfile>
7383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7384 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7385 to verify server's certificate.
7386
7387 Supported in default-server: No
7388
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007389crt <cert>
7390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7391 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7392 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7393 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7394 certificate request.
7395
7396 Supported in default-server: No
7397
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007398disabled
7399 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7400 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7401 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7402 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7403 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7404
7405 Supported in default-server: No
7406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007407error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007408 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7409 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7410 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007412 Supported in default-server: Yes
7413
7414 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007416fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007417 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7418 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7419 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007421 Supported in default-server: Yes
7422
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007423force-sslv3
7424 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7425 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7426 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7427
7428 Supported in default-server: No
7429
7430force-tlsv10
7431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7432 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7433
7434 Supported in default-server: No
7435
7436force-tlsv11
7437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7438 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7439
7440 Supported in default-server: No
7441
7442force-tlsv12
7443 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7444 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7445
7446 Supported in default-server: No
7447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007448id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007449 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7450 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7451 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007453 Supported in default-server: No
7454
7455inter <delay>
7456fastinter <delay>
7457downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007458 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7459 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7460 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7461 between checks depending on the server state :
7462
7463 Server state | Interval used
7464 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7465 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7466 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7467 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7468 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7469 or yet unchecked. |
7470 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7471 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7472 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007474 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7475 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7476 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7477 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7478 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7479 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7480 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7481 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7482 servers.
7483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007484 Supported in default-server: Yes
7485
7486maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007487 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7488 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7489 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7490 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7491 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7492 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7493 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7494 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007496 Supported in default-server: Yes
7497
7498maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007499 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7500 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7501 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7502 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7503 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7504 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7505 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007507 Supported in default-server: Yes
7508
7509minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007510 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7511 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7512 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7513 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7514 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7515 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007516 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007517 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007519 Supported in default-server: Yes
7520
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007521no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007522 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7523 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007524 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007525
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007526 Supported in default-server: No
7527
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007528no-tls-tickets
7529 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7530 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7531 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7532 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7533
7534 Supported in default-server: No
7535
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007536no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007537 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007538 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7539 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007540 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7541 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007542
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007543 Supported in default-server: No
7544
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007545no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007546 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007547 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7548 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007549 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7550 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007551
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007552 Supported in default-server: No
7553
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007554no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007555 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007556 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7557 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007558 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7559 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007560
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007561 Supported in default-server: No
7562
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007563non-stick
7564 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7565 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7566 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7567
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007568 Supported in default-server: No
7569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007570observe <mode>
7571 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7572 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7573 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7574 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7575 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7576 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007577 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007579 Supported in default-server: No
7580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007581 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007583on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007584 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7585 Currently, four modes are available:
7586 - fastinter: force fastinter
7587 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7588 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7589 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7590 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007592 Supported in default-server: Yes
7593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007594 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7595
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007596on-marked-down <action>
7597 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7598 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007599 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7600 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7601 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7602 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7603 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7604 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7605 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7606 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007607
7608 Actions are disabled by default
7609
7610 Supported in default-server: Yes
7611
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007612on-marked-up <action>
7613 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7614 Currently one action is available:
7615 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7616 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7617 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7618 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7619 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7620 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7621 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7622 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7623
7624 Actions are disabled by default
7625
7626 Supported in default-server: Yes
7627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007628port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007629 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7630 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7631 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7632 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7633 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7634 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007636 Supported in default-server: Yes
7637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007638redir <prefix>
7639 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7640 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7641 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7642 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7643 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7644 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7645 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7646 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007647 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007648 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7649 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7650 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7651 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7652 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7653
7654 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007656 Supported in default-server: No
7657
7658rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007659 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7660 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7661 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007663 Supported in default-server: Yes
7664
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007665send-proxy
7666 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7667 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7668 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7669 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7670 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7671 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7672 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7673 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7674 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007675 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7676 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7677 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7678 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7679 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007680
7681 Supported in default-server: No
7682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007683slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007684 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7685 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7686 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7687 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7688 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7689 parameters :
7690
7691 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7692 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7693
7694 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7695 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7696 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7697 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7698
7699 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7700 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7701 seen as failed.
7702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007703 Supported in default-server: Yes
7704
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007705source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007707source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007708 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7709 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7710 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7711 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7712
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007713 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7714 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7715 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7716 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7717 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7718 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7719 server.
7720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007721 Supported in default-server: No
7722
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007723ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007724 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7725 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7726 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7727 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7728 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7729 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7730 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7731 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7732
7733 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007735track [<proxy>/]<server>
7736 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7737 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7738 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7739 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7740 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007742 Supported in default-server: No
7743
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007744verify [none|required]
7745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7746 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7747 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7748 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7749 is aborted.
7750
7751 Supported in default-server: No
7752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007753weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007754 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7755 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7756 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007757 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7758 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7759 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7760 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7761 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7762 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007764 Supported in default-server: Yes
7765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766
77676. HTTP header manipulation
7768---------------------------
7769
7770In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7771response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7772request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7773which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7774against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7775to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7776passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7777headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7778never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7779
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007780There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7781(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7782rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7783messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7784in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007785happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007786add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7787normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007789This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7790in section 4.2 :
7791
7792 - reqadd <string>
7793 - reqallow <search>
7794 - reqiallow <search>
7795 - reqdel <search>
7796 - reqidel <search>
7797 - reqdeny <search>
7798 - reqideny <search>
7799 - reqpass <search>
7800 - reqipass <search>
7801 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7802 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7803 - reqtarpit <search>
7804 - reqitarpit <search>
7805 - rspadd <string>
7806 - rspdel <search>
7807 - rspidel <search>
7808 - rspdeny <search>
7809 - rspideny <search>
7810 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7811 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7812
7813With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7814is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7815parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7816prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7817Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7818
7819 \t for a tab
7820 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7821 \n for a new line (LF)
7822 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7823 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7824 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7825 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7826 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7827
7828The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7829portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7830above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7831regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
78329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7833is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7834
7835The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7836after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7837
7838Notes related to these keywords :
7839---------------------------------
7840 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7841 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7842 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7843
7844 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7845 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7846 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7847
7848 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7849 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7850 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7851 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7852 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7853
7854 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7855 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7856 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7857 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7858 useless headers before adding new ones.
7859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007860 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007861 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7862
7863 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7864 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7865 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7866
7867 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7868 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007869 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007870
7871
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078727. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7873------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007874
7875The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7876content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7877from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7878simple :
7879
7880 - define test criteria with sets of values
7881 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7882
7883The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7884
7885In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7886
7887 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7888
7889This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7890Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7891and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7892an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7893of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7894
7895ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7896'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7897which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7898
7899There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7900performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7901
7902The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7903
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007904 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7905 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007906 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7907
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007908The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7909specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7910possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007911multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7912be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7913needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7914space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7915match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7916lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7917duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007918to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007919instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007920
7921 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7922
7923In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7924the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7925case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7926too.
7927
7928Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7929a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7930ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007932Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007933
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007934 - integers or integer ranges
7935 - strings
7936 - regular expressions
7937 - IP addresses and networks
7938
7939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079407.1. Matching integers
7941----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007942
7943Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7944that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7945expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7946may be omitted.
7947
7948For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7949unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7950representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7951
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007952As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7953two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7954instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7955ranges and operators.
7956
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007957For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007958operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7959Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7960of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007962Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007963
7964 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7965 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7966 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7967 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7968 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007970For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007971
7972 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7973
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007974This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7975
7976 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7977
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079797.2. Matching strings
7980---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007981
7982String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7983exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7984characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7985string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7986to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007987before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007988
7989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079907.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7991-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007992
7993Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7994they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7995possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7996passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7997the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007998the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7999match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008000
8001
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020080027.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008003----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008004
8005IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8006netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8007within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008008host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008009difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8010at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8011does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8012parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008013
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008014IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8015Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8016trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8017IPv6 patterns.
8018
8019HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8020following situations :
8021 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8022 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8023 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8024 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8025 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8026 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8027 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8028 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8029 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8030 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080337.5. Available matching criteria
8034--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080367.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8037------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008038
8039A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8040analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008041addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008043always_false
8044 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8045 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8046
8047always_true
8048 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8049 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8050
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008051avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008052avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008053 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8054 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8055 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8056 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8057 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8058 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8059 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8060 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8061 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8062 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8063 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008064
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008065be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008066be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008067 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8068 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8069 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8070 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8071 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008072
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008073be_id <integer>
8074 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8075 backend it was called.
8076
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008077be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008078be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008079 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8080 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8081 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8082 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8083 sucking of an online dictionary).
8084
8085 Example :
8086 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8087 backend dynamic
8088 mode http
8089 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8090 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008091
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008092srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8093 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8094 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8095 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8096 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8097 latent requests from overloading servers).
8098
8099 Example :
8100 # Redirect to a separate back
8101 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8102 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8103 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8104
8105
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008106connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008107connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008108 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008109 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008110 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8111
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008112 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8113 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008114
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008115 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008116 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8117 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8118 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8119 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8120 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008121 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008122
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008123 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8124 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8125 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8126 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008128dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008129 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8130 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008132dst_conn <integer>
8133 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8134 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8135 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8136 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8137 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8138 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8139
8140dst_port <integer>
8141 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8142 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8143
8144fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008145fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008146 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8147 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8148 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8149 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8150 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8151 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8152 criteria.
8153
8154fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008155 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008156 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008157
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008158fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008159fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008160 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8161 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8162 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8163 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8164 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8165 the rate to go down below the limit.
8166
8167 Example :
8168 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8169 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8170 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8171 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8172 frontend mail
8173 bind :25
8174 mode tcp
8175 maxconn 100
8176 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8177 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8178 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8179 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008180
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008181nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008182nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8184 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8185 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8186 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8187 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008188
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008189queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008190queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008191 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8192 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8193 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8194 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8195 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8196 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8197 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008199sc1_bytes_in_rate
8200sc2_bytes_in_rate
8201 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8202 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8203 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8204
8205sc1_bytes_out_rate
8206sc2_bytes_out_rate
8207 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8208 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8209 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8210
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008211sc1_clr_gpc0
8212sc2_clr_gpc0
8213 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8214 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8215 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8216 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8217 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8218 was verified :
8219
8220 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8221 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8222 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8223 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8224 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8225 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8226 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008228sc1_conn_cnt
8229sc2_conn_cnt
8230 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8231 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8232
8233sc1_conn_cur
8234sc2_conn_cur
8235 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8236 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8237 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8238
8239sc1_conn_rate
8240sc2_conn_rate
8241 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8242 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8243 See also src_conn_rate.
8244
8245sc1_get_gpc0
8246sc2_get_gpc0
8247 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8248 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8249
8250sc1_http_err_cnt
8251sc2_http_err_cnt
8252 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8253 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8254 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8255
8256sc1_http_err_rate
8257sc2_http_err_rate
8258 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8259 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8260 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8261 src_http_err_rate.
8262
8263sc1_http_req_cnt
8264sc2_http_req_cnt
8265 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8266 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8267 src_http_req_cnt.
8268
8269sc1_http_req_rate
8270sc2_http_req_rate
8271 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8272 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8273 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8274 src_http_req_rate.
8275
8276sc1_inc_gpc0
8277sc2_inc_gpc0
8278 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8279 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8280 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8281 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8282 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8283 when a first ACL was verified :
8284
8285 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8286 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8287 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8288
8289sc1_kbytes_in
8290sc2_kbytes_in
8291 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8292 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8293 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8294 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8295
8296sc1_kbytes_out
8297sc2_kbytes_out
8298 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8299 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8300 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8301 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8302
8303sc1_sess_cnt
8304sc2_sess_cnt
8305 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8306 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8307 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8308 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008309 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008310 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8311
8312sc1_sess_rate
8313sc2_sess_rate
8314 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8315 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8316 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8317 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8318 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008319 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008320
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008321sc1_trackers
8322sc2_trackers
8323 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8324 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8325 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8326 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8327 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8328 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8329
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008330so_id <integer>
8331 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8332
8333src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008334 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8335 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8336 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008337
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008338src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008339src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008340 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8341 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8342 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008343 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008344
8345src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008346src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008347 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8348 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8349 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008350 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008351
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008352src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8353src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8354 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8355 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8356 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8357 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8358 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8359 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8360
8361 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8362 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8363 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8364 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8365 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8366 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8367 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8368
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008369src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008370src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008371 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8372 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8373 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008374 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008375
8376src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008377src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008378 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8379 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8380 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008381 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008382
8383src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008384src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008385 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8386 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8387 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008388 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008389
8390src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008391src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008392 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8393 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8394 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008395 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008396
8397src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008398src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008399 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8400 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8401 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008402 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008403
8404src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008405src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008406 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8407 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8408 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8409 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008410 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008411
8412src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008413src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008414 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8415 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8416 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008417 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008418
8419src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008420src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008421 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8422 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8423 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8424 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008425 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008426
8427src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008428src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008429 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8430 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8431 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8432 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8433 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8434 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8435
8436 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8437 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008438 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008439
8440src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008441src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008442 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8443 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8444 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8445 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008446 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008447
8448src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008449src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008450 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8451 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8452 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8453 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008454 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008455
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008456src_port <integer>
8457 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008458
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008459src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008460src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008461 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8462 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8463 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8464 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008465 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008466
8467src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008468src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008469 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8470 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8471 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8472 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008473 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008474
8475src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008476src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008477 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008478 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8479 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008480 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8481 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8482 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008483 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008484
8485 Example :
8486 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8487 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8488 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8489 listen ssh
8490 bind :22
8491 mode tcp
8492 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008493 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008494 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8495 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8496
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008497srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008498 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8499 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8500 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8501 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8502
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008503srv_id <integer>
8504 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8505
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008506srv_is_up(<server>)
8507srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8508 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8509 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8510 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8511 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8512 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8513 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8514 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8515 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8516
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008517table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008518table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008519 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8520 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8521
8522table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008523table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008524 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8525 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8526 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020085297.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8530---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008531
8532A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8533during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008534through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8535keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008536
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008537rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8538 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8539 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8540 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008541 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8542 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8543 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008544
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008545req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008546 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008547 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8548 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8549 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8550 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8551 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8552 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8553
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008554req_proto_http
8555 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8556 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008557 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008558 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8559 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8560
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008561req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008562req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008563 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8564 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8565 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8566 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8567 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8568 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8569 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8570 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8571
8572req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008573req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008574 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8575 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8576 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8577 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8578 cookies.
8579
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008580req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8581 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8582 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8583 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008584 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8585 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8586 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008587
8588req_ssl_sni <string>
8589 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8590 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8591 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8592 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8593 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8594 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8595 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008596 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8597 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008598 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008599 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008600
8601 Examples :
8602 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8603 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8604 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8605 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8606 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8607
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008608req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8609 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8610 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8611 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8612 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8613 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8614 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008615 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8616 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008617 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008618 option.
8619
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008620ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8621 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8622 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8623 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8624 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8625 during this verification process.
8626
8627ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8628 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8629 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8630 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8631 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8632
8633ssl_c_err <integer>
8634 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8635 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8636 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8637 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8638
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008639ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8640ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8641 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8642 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8643 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8644 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8645 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8646 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8647 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8648 DN matches the specified string.
8649
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008650ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8651 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8652 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8653 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8654
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008655ssl_c_notafter <string>
8656 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8657 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8658 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8659
8660ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8661 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8662 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8663 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8664
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008665ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8666ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8667 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8668 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8669 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8670 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8671 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8672 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8673 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8674 DN matches the specified string.
8675
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008676ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8677 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8678 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8679 the value written in hexa.
8680
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008681ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8682 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8683 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8684 by the client matches the string.
8685
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008686ssl_c_used
8687 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8688 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8689
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008690ssl_c_verify <integer>
8691 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8692 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8693 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8694
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008695ssl_c_version <integer>
8696 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8697 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8698 the value.
8699
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008700ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8701ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8702 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8703 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8704 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8705 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8706 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8707 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8708 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8709 DN matches the specified string.
8710
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008711ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8712 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8713 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8714 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8715
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008716ssl_f_notafter <string>
8717 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8718 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8719 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8720
8721ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8722 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8723 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8724 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8725
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008726ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8727ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8728 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8729 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8730 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8731 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8732 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8733 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8734 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8735 DN matches the specified string.
8736
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008737ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8738 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8739 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8740 the value written in hexa.
8741
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008742ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8743 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8744 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8745 by the frontend matches the string.
8746
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008747ssl_f_version <integer>
8748 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8749 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8750 the value.
8751
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008752ssl_fc
8753 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8754 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8755 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8756
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008757ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8758 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8759 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8760
8761ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8762 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8763 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8764
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008765ssl_fc_has_crt
8766 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8767 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008768 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8769 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8770 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8771 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008772
8773ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008774 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008775 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8776 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8777 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8778 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008779
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008780ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008781 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8782 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8783 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8784 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008785 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8786 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8787 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008788
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008789ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8790 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8791 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8792
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008793ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008794 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8795 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8796 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8797 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008798 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8799 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008800 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8801 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8802 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008803
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008804ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008805 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8806 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8807 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8808 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008809 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8810 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8811 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8812 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008813
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008814ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008815 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8816 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8817 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8818 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008819 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8820 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8821 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8822 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008823
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008824ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8825 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8826 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8827
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008828wait_end
8829 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8830 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8831 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8832 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8833 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8834 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8835 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8836 inspection.
8837
8838 Examples :
8839 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8840 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8841 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8842
8843 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8844 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8845 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8846 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8847 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8848 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8849 tcp-request content reject
8850
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088527.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8853--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008854
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008855A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008856application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8857read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8858than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8859
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008860base <string>
8861 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8862 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8863 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8864 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8865 See also "path" and "uri".
8866
8867base_beg <string>
8868 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8869 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8870 "path_beg".
8871
8872base_dir <string>
8873 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8874 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8875 "path_dir" instead.
8876
8877base_dom <string>
8878 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8879 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8880 instead.
8881
8882base_end <string>
8883 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8884 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8885
8886base_len <integer>
8887 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8888 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8889
8890base_reg <regex>
8891 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8892 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8893 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8894 and all "base_" criteria.
8895
8896base_sub <string>
8897 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8898 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8899 also "base_dir".
8900
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008901cook(<name>) <string>
8902 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8903 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8904 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8905 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8906 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8907 sent by the server.
8908
8909 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8910 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8911 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8912
8913 cook(profile) silver gold
8914
8915cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8916 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8917 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8918 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8919
8920cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8921 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8922 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8923 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8924 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8925 server.
8926
8927cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8928 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8929 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8930 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8931 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8932 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8933
8934cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8935 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8936 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8937 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8938 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8939
8940cook_end(<name>) <string>
8941 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8942 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8943 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8944
8945cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8946 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8947 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8948 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8949 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8950 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8951
8952cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8953 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8954 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8955 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8956 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8957 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8958
8959cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8960 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8961 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8962 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8963
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008964cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8965 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8966 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8967 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8968 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8969 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008971hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008972hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008973 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8974 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8975 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8976 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008977 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8978 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8979 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8980 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8981 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008982
8983 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008984 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008985 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8986
8987 hdr(Connection) -i close
8988
8989hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008990hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008991 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8992 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8993 response headers sent by the server.
8994
8995hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008996hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008997 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8998 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8999 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9000 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9001 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9002 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9003 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9004
9005hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009006hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009007 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9008 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9009 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9010 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9011 headers sent by the server.
9012
9013hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009014hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009015 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9016 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9017 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9018 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9019 server.
9020
9021hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009022hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009023 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9024 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9025 response headers sent by the server.
9026
9027hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009028hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9029 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9030 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9031 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009032 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9033
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009034hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009035hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009036 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9037 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9038 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9039 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9040
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009041hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009042hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009043 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009044 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9045 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9046 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9047 response headers sent by the server.
9048
9049hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009050hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009051 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9052 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9053 response headers sent by the server.
9054
9055hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009056hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009057 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9058 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9059 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9060 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9061
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009062http_auth(<userlist>)
9063http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009064 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9065 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9066 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9067 of specified groups.
9068
9069 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9070
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009071http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009072 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9073 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9074 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9075 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9076
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009077method <string>
9078 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9079 already check for most common methods.
9080
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009081path <string>
9082 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9083 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9084 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9085
9086path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009087 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9088 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009089
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009090path_dir <string>
9091 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9092 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9093 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9094 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9095
9096path_dom <string>
9097 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9098 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9099 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9100
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009101path_end <string>
9102 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9103 control file name extension.
9104
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009105path_len <integer>
9106 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9107 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009109path_reg <regex>
9110 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9111 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9112 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009114path_sub <string>
9115 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9116 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9117 "path_dir".
9118
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009119payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9120 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9121 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9122 strings.
9123
9124payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9125 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9126 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9127 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9128 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9129 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009131req_ver <string>
9132 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9133 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9134
9135status <integer>
9136 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9137 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9138 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009140url <string>
9141 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009142 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009143
9144url_beg <string>
9145 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009146 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9147 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009149url_dir <string>
9150 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9151 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9152 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9153 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9154
9155url_dom <string>
9156 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9157 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9158 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9159
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009160url_end <string>
9161 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9162 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009163
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009164url_ip <address>
9165 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9166 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9167 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009168
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009169url_len <integer>
9170 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9171 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9172
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009173url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009174 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9175 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009176 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009177 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009179url_reg <regex>
9180 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9181 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009182 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009184url_sub <string>
9185 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9186 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009187
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009188urlp(<name>) <string>
9189 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9190 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9191
9192 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9193 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9194
9195urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9196 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9197 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9198 protocol scheme.
9199
9200urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9201 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9202 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9203 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9204 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9205
9206urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9207 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9208 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9209 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9210 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9211
9212urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9213 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9214
9215urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009216 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9217 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009218
9219urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9220 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9221 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9222
9223urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9224 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9225 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9226 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9227 "urlp_" criteria.
9228
9229urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9230 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9231 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9232 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9233
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009234urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9235 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9236 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9237 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9238 negative data.
9239
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092417.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9242---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009244Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9245every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009246order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009248ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9249---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009250FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009251HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009252HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9253HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009254HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9255HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9256HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9257HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9258LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009259METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9260METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9261METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9262METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9263METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9264METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009265RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009266REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009267TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009268WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9269---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009270
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9273----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009275Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9276combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009278 - AND (implicit)
9279 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9280 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009282A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009284 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009286Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9287indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9290"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9291requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9292is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9295 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9296 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9297 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009299To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9300and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009302 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9303 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9304 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9305 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009307 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9308 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9309 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9310 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009311
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009312It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9313expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9314be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009315the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009316
9317 The following rule :
9318
9319 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9320 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9321
9322 Can also be written that way :
9323
9324 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9325
9326It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9327to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9328simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9329sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9330good use is the following :
9331
9332 With named ACLs :
9333
9334 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9335 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9336 monitor fail if site_dead
9337
9338 With anonymous ACLs :
9339
9340 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009342See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009343
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009344
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010093457.8. Pattern extraction
9346-----------------------
9347
9348The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9349response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9350for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9351
9352All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9353"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9354begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9355arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9356much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9357equivalent used in ACLs.
9358
9359The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9360
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009361 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9362 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9363 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9364 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9365 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9366 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9367 requested objects by host/path.
9368
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009369 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9370 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9371 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9372 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9373 is an unsigned integer.
9374
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009375 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9376 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9377 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9378 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9379
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009380 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009381 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9382 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9383 according to RFC 4291.
9384
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009385 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9386 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9387 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009388 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9389 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9390 according to RFC 4291.
9391
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009392 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9393 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9394 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9395 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9396 type integer and only works with such tables.
9397
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009398 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9399 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9400 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9401 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9402 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9403 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9404 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009405 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009406
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009407 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9408 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9409 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9410 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9411 wiser to use "url" instead.
9412
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009413 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009414 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9415 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9416 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9417 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009418
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009419 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009420 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9421 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9422 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9423 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9424 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9425 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9426 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9427 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009428
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009429 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9430 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9431 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9432 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9433
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009434 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9435 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9436
9437 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9438 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9439 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9440
9441 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9442 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9443
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009444 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9445 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9446 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9447 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9448 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9449 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9450 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9451 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9452 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9453 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9454 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9455
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009456 ssl_c_key_alg
9457 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9458 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9459 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9460
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009461 ssl_c_notafter
9462 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9463 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9464 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9465
9466 ssl_c_notbefore
9467 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9468 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9469 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9470
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009471 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9472 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9473 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9474 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9475 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9476 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9477 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9478 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9479 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9480 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9481 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9482
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009483 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9484 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9485 layer.
9486
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009487 ssl_c_sig_alg
9488 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9489 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9490 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9491
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009492 ssl_c_used
9493 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9494 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9495
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009496 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9497 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9498 error is encountered.
9499
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009500 ssl_c_version
9501 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9502 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9503 layer.
9504
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009505 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9506 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9507 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9508 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9509 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9510 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9511 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9512 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9513 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9514 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9515 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9516
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009517 ssl_f_key_alg
9518 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9519 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9520 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9521
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009522 ssl_f_notafter
9523 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9524 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9525 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9526
9527 ssl_f_notbefore
9528 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9529 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9530 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9531
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009532 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9533 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9534 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9535 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9536 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9537 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9538 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9539 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9540 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9541 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9542 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9543
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009544 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9545 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9546 layer.
9547
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009548 ssl_f_sig_alg
9549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9550 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9551 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9552
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009553 ssl_f_version
9554 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9555 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9556 layer.
9557
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009558 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9559 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9560 otherwise zero.
9561
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009562 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9563 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9564 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9565
9566 ssl_fc_cipher
9567 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9568 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9569
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009570 ssl_fc_has_crt
9571 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9572 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009573 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9574 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9575 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9576 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9577 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009578
9579 ssl_fc_has_sni
9580 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009581 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9582 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009583 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009584 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009585
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009586 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009587 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9588 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9589 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9590 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009591 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009592
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009593 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009594 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9595 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009596
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009597 ssl_fc_session_id
9598 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9599 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9600 stick on a given client.
9601
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009602 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009603 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9604 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9605 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9606 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9607 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009608
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009609 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9610 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9611 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9612
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009613 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9614 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9615 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9616 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9617
9618 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9619 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9620 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9621 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9622 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9623 table for a given source address.
9624
9625 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9626 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9627
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009628 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009629 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009630 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9631 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9632 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9633 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9634 where cookies cannot be used.
9635
9636 Example :
9637 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9638 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9639 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9640 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009641
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009642 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009643 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9644 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9645 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9646 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009647
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009648 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9649 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9650 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9651 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9652 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9653 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9654 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009655
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009656 Example :
9657 listen tse-farm
9658 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9659 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9660 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9661 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9662 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9663 persist rdp-cookie
9664 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9665 # This is only useful makes sense if
9666 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9667 stick-table type string size 204800
9668 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9669 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9670 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009671
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009672 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9673 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009674
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009675 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009676 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009677 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9678 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9679 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9680 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9681 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9682 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009683
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009684 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009685
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009686 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009687 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9688 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9689 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9690
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009691 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9692 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9693 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9694 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9695 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009696
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009697 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009698
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009700The currently available list of transformations include :
9701
9702 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9703 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9704 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9705
9706 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9707 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9708 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9709
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009710 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009711 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9712 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9713 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9714 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9715
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097178. Logging
9718----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009720One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9721provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9722very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9723provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9724state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009725to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009726headers.
9727
9728In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9729about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9730send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9731
9732 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9733 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9734 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9735 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9736 at the termination.
9737
9738The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9739allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9740as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9741while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9742real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9743delay.
9744
9745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097468.1. Log levels
9747---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009748
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009749TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009750source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009751HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9752in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9753track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9754syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9755about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009756
9757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097588.2. Log formats
9759----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009760
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009761HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009762and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9763slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9764options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009765
9766 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9767 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9768 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9769 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9770 extents.
9771
9772 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9773 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9774 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9775 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9776 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9777
9778 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9779 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9780 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9781 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9782 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9783
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009784 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9785 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9786 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9787 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9788
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009789 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9790
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009791Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9792specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9793field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9794servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9795always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9796identifier.
9797
9798Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9799 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9800 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9801 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9802 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9803
9804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098058.2.1. Default log format
9806-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009807
9808This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9809as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9810format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9811
9812 Example :
9813 listen www
9814 mode http
9815 log global
9816 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9817
9818 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9819 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9820 (www/HTTP)
9821
9822 Field Format Extract from the example above
9823 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9824 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9825 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9826 4 'to' to
9827 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9828 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9829
9830Detailed fields description :
9831 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9832 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9833 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9834 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9835 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9836 and processed the connection.
9837 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9838
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009839In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9840"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9841connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009843It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9844will eventually disappear.
9845
9846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098478.2.2. TCP log format
9848---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009849
9850The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9851is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9852information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9853counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9854emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9855environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9856the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9857sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009858specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9859not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9860fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9861marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009862
9863 Example :
9864 frontend fnt
9865 mode tcp
9866 option tcplog
9867 log global
9868 default_backend bck
9869
9870 backend bck
9871 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9872
9873 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9874 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9875 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9876
9877 Field Format Extract from the example above
9878 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9879 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9880 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9881 4 frontend_name fnt
9882 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9883 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9884 7 bytes_read* 212
9885 8 termination_state --
9886 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9887 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9888
9889Detailed fields description :
9890 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009891 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9892 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9893 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9894 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9895 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009896
9897 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009898 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9899 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9900 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009901
9902 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9903 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9904 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9905 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9906
9907 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9908 and processed the connection.
9909
9910 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9911 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9912 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9913 applications.
9914
9915 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9916 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9917 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9918 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9919 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9920
9921 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9922 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9923 See "Timers" below for more details.
9924
9925 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9926 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9927 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9928 "Timers" below for more details.
9929
9930 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9931 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9932 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9933 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9934 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9935 details.
9936
9937 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9938 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9939 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9940 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9941 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9942
9943 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9944 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9945 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9946 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9947 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9948 for more details.
9949
9950 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009951 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009952 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9953 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9954 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009955 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009956
9957 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9958 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9959 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9960 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9961 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9962 caused by a denial of service attack.
9963
9964 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9965 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9966 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9967 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9968 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9969 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9970 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9971 denial of service attack.
9972
9973 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9974 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9975 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9976 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9977 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9978 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9979 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9980 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9981 be processed than on other servers.
9982
9983 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9984 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9985 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9986 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9987 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9988 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9989 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9990 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9991 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9992 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9993 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9994 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9995 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9996
9997 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9998 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9999 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10000 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10001 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10002 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10003 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10004 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10005
10006 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10007 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10008 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10009 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10010 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10011 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10012 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10013 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10014 occurs.
10015
10016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100178.2.3. HTTP log format
10018----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010019
10020The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10021is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10022the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10023are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10024emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10025generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10026"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10027which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010028frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10029is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010030
10031Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10032slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10033with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10034
10035 Example :
10036 frontend http-in
10037 mode http
10038 option httplog
10039 log global
10040 default_backend bck
10041
10042 backend static
10043 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10044
10045 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10046 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10047 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010048 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010049
10050 Field Format Extract from the example above
10051 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10052 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10053 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10054 4 frontend_name http-in
10055 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10056 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10057 7 status_code 200
10058 8 bytes_read* 2750
10059 9 captured_request_cookie -
10060 10 captured_response_cookie -
10061 11 termination_state ----
10062 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10063 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10064 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10065 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10066 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010067
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010068
10069Detailed fields description :
10070 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010071 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10072 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10073 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10074 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10075 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010076
10077 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010078 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10079 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10080 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010081
10082 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10083 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10084 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10085 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10086 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10087
10088 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10089 and processed the connection.
10090
10091 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10092 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10093 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10094
10095 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10096 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10097 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10098 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10099 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10100 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10101
10102 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10103 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10104 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10105 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10106 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10107 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10108
10109 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10110 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10111 See "Timers" below for more details.
10112
10113 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10114 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10115 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10116 below for more details.
10117
10118 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10119 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10120 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10121 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10122 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10123 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10124 for more details.
10125
10126 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10127 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10128 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10129 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10130 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10131 details.
10132
10133 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10134 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10135 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10136
10137 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10138 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10139 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10140 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10141 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10142 overflowing.
10143
10144 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10145 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10146 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10147 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10148 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10149 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10150 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10151 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10152
10153 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10154 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10155 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10156 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10157 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10158 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10159 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10160 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10161
10162 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10163 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10164 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10165 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10166 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10167 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10168 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10169
10170 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010171 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010172 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10173 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10174 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010175 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010176 system.
10177
10178 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10179 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10180 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10181 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10182 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10183 caused by a denial of service attack.
10184
10185 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10186 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10187 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10188 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10189 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10190 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10191 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10192 denial of service attack.
10193
10194 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10195 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10196 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10197 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10198 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10199 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10200 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10201 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10202 processed than on other servers.
10203
10204 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10205 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10206 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10207 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10208 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10209 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10210 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10211 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10212 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10213 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10214 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10215 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10216 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10217
10218 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10219 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10220 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10221 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10222 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10223 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10224 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10225 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10226
10227 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10228 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10229 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10230 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10231 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10232 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10233 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10234 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10235 occurs.
10236
10237 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10238 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10239 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10240 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10241 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10242 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10243 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10244 cookies" below for more details.
10245
10246 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10247 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10248 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10249 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10250 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10251 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10252 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10253 and cookies" below for more details.
10254
10255 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10256 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10257 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10258 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10259 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10260 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10261 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10262 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10263
10264
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200102658.2.4. Custom log format
10266------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010267
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010268The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010269mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010270
10271HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10272Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10273separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10274prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10275
10276Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10277variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10278string formats ("Q").
10279
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010280If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10281as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10282less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10283the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10284
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010285Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10286HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10287
10288Flags are :
10289 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010290 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010291
10292 Example:
10293
10294 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10295 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10296
10297At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10298
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010299 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10300 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010301
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010302the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010303
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010304 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010305 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010306 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010307
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010308and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10309
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010310 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010311 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10312
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010313Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10314
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010315 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010316 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010317 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10318 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10319 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010320 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10321 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10322 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010323 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010324 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010325 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010326 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010327 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010328 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010329 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10330 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010331 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010332 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10333 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010334 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010335 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10336 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010337 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10338 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10339 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010340 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010341 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10342 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010343 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010344 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10345 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10346 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010347 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010348 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10349 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10350 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10351 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010352 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010353 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010354 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010355 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010356 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010357 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010358 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10359 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10360 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010361 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010362 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10363 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010364 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010365 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010366 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010367 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010368
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010369 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010370
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010371
103728.2.5. Error log format
10373-----------------------
10374
10375When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10376protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10377By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10378"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10379will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10380logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10381
10382The format looks like this :
10383
10384 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10385 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10386 Connection error during SSL handshake
10387
10388 Field Format Extract from the example above
10389 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10390 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10391 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10392 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10393 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10394
10395These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10396failures.
10397
10398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103998.3. Advanced logging options
10400-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010401
10402Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10403just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10404options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10405for more information about their usage.
10406
10407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10409------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010410
10411It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10412haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10413commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10414monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10415ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10416
10417 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10418 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10419 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10420 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10421
10422 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10423 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10424 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10425 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10426 such as other load-balancers.
10427
10428 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10429 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10430 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10431
10432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10434----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010435
10436The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10437what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10438or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10439"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10440just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10441log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10442after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10443is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10444with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10445with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10446
10447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10449------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010450
10451Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10452for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10453"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10454retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10455raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10456a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10457file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10458you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10459"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10460
10461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10463--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010464
10465Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10466multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10467them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10468"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10469logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10470error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10471and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10472too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10473useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10474alternative.
10475
10476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104778.4. Timing events
10478------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010479
10480Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10481reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10482the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10483frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10484mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10485
10486 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10487 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10488 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10489 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10490 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10491
10492 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10493 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10494 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10495 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10496 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10497
10498 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10499 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10500 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10501 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10502 connection never established.
10503
10504 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10505 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10506 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10507 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10508 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10509 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10510 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10511 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10512 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10513 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10514 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10515
10516 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10517 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10518 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10519 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10520 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10521
10522 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10523
10524 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10525 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10526 negative.
10527
10528These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10529protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10530that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010531due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010532close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10533session has been aborted on timeout.
10534
10535Most common cases :
10536
10537 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10538 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10539 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10540 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10541 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10542 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10543 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10544 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10545 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010546 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10547 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10548 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010549
10550 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10551 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10552 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10553 of ms on remote networks.
10554
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010555 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10556 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10557 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010558
10559 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10560 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10561 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10562 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10563 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10564 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10565 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10566 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10567 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10568 to the server until another one is released.
10569
10570Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10571
10572 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10573 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10574 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10575
10576 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10577 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10578 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10579
10580 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10581 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10582 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10583 flags.
10584
10585 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10586 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10587 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10588 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10589 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10590 the client connection was maintained open.
10591
10592 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10593 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10594 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10595 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10596
10597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105988.5. Session state at disconnection
10599-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010600
10601TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10602"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
106032-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10604each of which has a special meaning :
10605
10606 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10607 session to terminate :
10608
10609 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10610
10611 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10612 server explicitly refused it.
10613
10614 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10615 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10616 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10617 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10618 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10619 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10620
10621 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10622 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10623 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10624 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10625 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10626
10627 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10628 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10629 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10630 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10631 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10632
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010633 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10634 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10635
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010636 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10637 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10638 backup connections when going up.
10639
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010640 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010642 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10643 send or receive data.
10644
10645 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10646 send or receive data.
10647
10648 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10649 with nothing left in the buffers.
10650
10651 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10652
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010653 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010654 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10655
10656 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10657 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10658 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10659 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10660 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10661
10662 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10663 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10664
10665 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10666 server (HTTP only).
10667
10668 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10669
10670 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10671 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10672 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10673
10674 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10675 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10676 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10677
10678 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10679
10680 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10681 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10682
10683 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10684 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10685 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10686
10687 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10688 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010689 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10690 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010691
10692 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10693 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10694 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10695 another server.
10696
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010697 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010698 server.
10699
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010700 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10701 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10702 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10703 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10704
10705 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10706 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10707 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10708 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10709
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010710 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10711 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10712 "use-server" rule).
10713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010714 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10715
10716 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10717 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10718
10719 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10720
10721 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10722 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10723 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10724
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010725 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10726 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10727 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10728 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10729 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010731 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10732
10733 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10734 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10735
10736 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10737
10738 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10739
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010740The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10741was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010742helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10743starvation, attacks, etc...
10744
10745The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10746alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10747easier finding and understanding.
10748
10749 Flags Reason
10750
10751 -- Normal termination.
10752
10753 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10754 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10755 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10756 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10757
10758 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10759 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10760 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10761 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10762 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10763 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010764
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010765 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10766 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010767 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010768
10769 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10770 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10771 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10772
10773 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10774 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10775 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10776 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10777 the server takes too long to respond.
10778
10779 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10780 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10781 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10782 long a time to respond.
10783
10784 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10785 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10786 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10787 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10788 and the client.
10789
10790 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10791 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10792 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10793 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10794 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10795 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10796
10797 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10798 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010799 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10800 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10801 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10802 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010804 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010805 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10806 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10807 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10808 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10809 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10810
10811 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10812 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10813 503 or 504 here.
10814
10815 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10816 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10817 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10818 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10819 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10820
10821 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10822 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010823 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010824 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10825 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10826
10827 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10828 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10829 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10830 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10831 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10832 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10833 between haproxy and the server.
10834
10835 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10836 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10837 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10838 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10839 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10840 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10841 solution is to fix the application.
10842
10843 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10844 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10845 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10846 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10847 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10848 external attacks.
10849
10850 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10851 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010852 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010853 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10854 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10855
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010856 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10857 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10858 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10859 the client.
10860
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010861 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10862 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10863 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10864 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010865 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10866 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10867 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10868 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10869 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010870
10871 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10872 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10873 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10874 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10875
10876 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10877 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10878 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10879 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10880
10881 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10882 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10883 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10884 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10885
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010886The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10887persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10888important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10889re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10890
10891 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10892
10893 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10894 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10895 set on a GET request.
10896
10897 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10898 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010899 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010900 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10901
10902 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10903 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10904 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10905
10906 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10907 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10908 already got a cookie.
10909
10910 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10911 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10912 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10913 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10914 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10915
10916 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10917 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10918 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10919
10920 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10921 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10922 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10923
10924 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10925 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10926
10927 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10928 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10929 then advertised in the response.
10930
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109328.6. Non-printable characters
10933-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010934
10935In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10936consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10937converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10938prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10939being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10940escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10941is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10942'}' when logging headers.
10943
10944Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10945issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10946containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10947
10948Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10949the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10950performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10951
10952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10954---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010955
10956Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10957achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010958section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010959cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10960the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10961the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010962locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010963not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10964user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10965a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10966wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10967
10968 Examples :
10969 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10970 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10971
10972 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10973 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10974
10975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10977---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010978
10979Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10980proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10981the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10982server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10983
10984Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10985response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010986section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010987
10988It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010989time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10990appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010991are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10992and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10993follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10994request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10995in the logs.
10996
10997 Example :
10998 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10999 listen proxy-out
11000 mode http
11001 option httplog
11002 option logasap
11003 log global
11004 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11005
11006 # log the name of the virtual server
11007 capture request header Host len 20
11008
11009 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11010 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11011
11012 # log the beginning of the referrer
11013 capture request header Referer len 20
11014
11015 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11016 capture response header Server len 20
11017
11018 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11019 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11020
11021 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11022 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11023
11024 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11025 capture response header Via len 20
11026
11027 # log the URL location during a redirection
11028 capture response header Location len 20
11029
11030 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11031 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11032 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11033 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11034 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11035
11036 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11037 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11038 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11039 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011040 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011041
11042 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11043 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11044 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11045 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11046 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011047 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011048
11049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110508.9. Examples of logs
11051---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011052
11053These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11054them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11055reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11056
11057 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11058 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11059 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11060
11061 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11062 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11063
11064 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11065 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11066 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11067
11068 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11069 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11070
11071 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11072 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11073 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11074
11075 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011076 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011077 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11078 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11079
11080 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11081 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11082 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11083
11084 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11085 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011086 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011087 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11088 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11089 to return the 502 and not the server.
11090
11091 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011092 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011093
11094 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11095 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11096 Nothing was sent to any server.
11097
11098 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11099 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11100
11101 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11102 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11103 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11104 send a 408 return code to the client.
11105
11106 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11107 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11108
11109 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11110 5 seconds ("c----").
11111
11112 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11113 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011114 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011115
11116 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011117 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011118 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11119 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11120 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11121 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11122 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011123
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111259. Statistics and monitoring
11126----------------------------
11127
11128It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11129mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11130CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11131Unix socket.
11132
11133
111349.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011135---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011136
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011137The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11138page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011140 0. pxname: proxy name
11141 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11142 for server)
11143 2. qcur: current queued requests
11144 3. qmax: max queued requests
11145 4. scur: current sessions
11146 5. smax: max sessions
11147 6. slim: sessions limit
11148 7. stot: total sessions
11149 8. bin: bytes in
11150 9. bout: bytes out
11151 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011152 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011153 12. ereq: request errors
11154 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011155 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011156 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11157 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011158 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011159 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11160 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11161 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11162 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11163 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11164 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11165 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11166 25. qlimit: queue limit
11167 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11168 27. iid: unique proxy id
11169 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11170 29. throttle: warm up status
11171 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11172 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011173 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011174 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11175 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11176 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011177 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011178 UNK -> unknown
11179 INI -> initializing
11180 SOCKERR -> socket error
11181 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11182 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11183 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11184 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11185 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11186 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11187 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11188 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11189 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11190 disable-on-404
11191 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11192 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11193 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011194 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11195 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011196 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11197 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11198 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11199 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11200 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11201 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011202 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11203 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11204 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11205 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011206 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11207 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011208 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11209 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11210 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011211 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011212
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112149.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011215-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011216
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011217The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011218must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11219is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11220a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11221risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11222followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11223given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11224then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11225to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011226
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011227It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11228on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11229own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011230
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011231clear counters
11232 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11233 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11234 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11235 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11236 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11237
11238clear counters all
11239 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11240 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11241 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11242
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011243clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11244 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11245
11246 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11247 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11248 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11249 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11250 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11251 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11252
11253 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11254
11255 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11256 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11257 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11258 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11259 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11260 the ACLs :
11261
11262 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11263 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11264 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11265 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11266 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11267 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11268
11269 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011270 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11271 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011272
11273 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011274 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011275 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011276 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11277 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11278 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11279 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011280
11281 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11282
11283 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011284 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011285 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11286 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011287 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11288 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11289 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011290
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011291disable frontend <frontend>
11292 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11293 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11294 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11295 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11296 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11297 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11298 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11299 on the stats page.
11300
11301 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11302 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11303
11304 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11305 level "admin".
11306
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011307disable server <backend>/<server>
11308 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11309 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11310 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11311 during the maintenance.
11312
11313 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11314 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11315
11316 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011317 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011318
11319 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11320 level "admin".
11321
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011322enable frontend <frontend>
11323 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11324 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11325 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11326 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11327 which was disabled.
11328
11329 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11330 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11331
11332 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11333 level "admin".
11334
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011335enable server <backend>/<server>
11336 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11337 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11338
11339 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011340 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011341
11342 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11343 level "admin".
11344
11345get weight <backend>/<server>
11346 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11347 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11348 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11349 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11350 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011351 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011352
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011353help
11354 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11355 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011356
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011357prompt
11358 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11359 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11360 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11361 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11362 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11363 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11364 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11365 command.
11366
11367quit
11368 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011369
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011370set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011371 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11372 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11373 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11374 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11375 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011376 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11377 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11378
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011379set maxconn global <maxconn>
11380 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11381 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11382 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11383 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11384 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11385 setting.
11386
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011387set rate-limit connections global <value>
11388 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11389 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11390 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11391 is passed in number of connections per second.
11392
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011393set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11394 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11395 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011396 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11397 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011398
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011399set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11400 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11401 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11402 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11403 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11404 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11405
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011406set timeout cli <delay>
11407 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11408 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11409 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11410
11411set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11412 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11413 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11414 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11415 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11416 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11417 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11418 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11419 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11420 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11421 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11422 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11423 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11424 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011425 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011426
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011427show errors [<iid>]
11428 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11429 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011430 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11431 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11432 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011433
11434 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11435 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11436 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11437 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11438 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11439 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11440 are reported too.
11441
11442 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11443 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11444 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11445 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11446 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11447 code.
11448
11449 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11450 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11451 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11452 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11453 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11454 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11455 line.
11456
11457 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011458 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11459 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011460 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11461 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11462
11463 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11464 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11465 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11466 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11467 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11468 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11469 00204+ minal\r\n
11470 00211 \r\n
11471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011472 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011473 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11474 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11475 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11476 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11477 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11478 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011479
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011480show info
11481 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11482
11483show sess
11484 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011485 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11486 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11487
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011488show sess <id>
11489 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11490 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11491 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11492 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11493 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011494 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11495 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11496 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011497
11498show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11499 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11500 possible to dump only selected items :
11501 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11502 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11503 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11504 for example:
11505 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11506 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11507 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11508
11509 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011510 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11511 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011512 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11513 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11514 Nbproc: 1
11515 Process_num: 1
11516 (...)
11517
11518 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11519 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11520 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11521 (...)
11522 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11523
11524 $
11525
11526 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11527 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11528 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11529 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011530 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011531
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011532show table
11533 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11534 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11535 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11536 entries currently in use.
11537
11538 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011539 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011540 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11541 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011542
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011543show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011544 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11545 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11546 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011547 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11548
11549 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11550 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11551 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11552 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11553 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11554
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011555 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11556 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11557 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11558 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11559 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11560 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11561
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011562
11563 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011564 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11565 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011566
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011567 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011568 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011569 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011570 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11571 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11572 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11573 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011574
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011575 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011576 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011577 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11578 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011579
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011580 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11581 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011582 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011583 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11584 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011585
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011586 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11587 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011588 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011589 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11590 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11591
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011592 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11593 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11594 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11595 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11596 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11597
11598 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11599 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11600 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011601 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11602 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011603 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11604 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011605
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011606shutdown frontend <frontend>
11607 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11608 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11609 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11610 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11611 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11612 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11613 once it is terminated.
11614
11615 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11616 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11617
11618 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11619 level "admin".
11620
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011621shutdown session <id>
11622 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11623 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11624 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11625 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11626 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11627 flag in the logs.
11628
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011629shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11630 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11631 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11632 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11633 'K' flag in the logs.
11634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011635/*
11636 * Local variables:
11637 * fill-column: 79
11638 * End:
11639 */